blob: 223184b2c508a38ed4c3b275e464dd1fa5c35f32 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaub3066502017-11-26 19:50:17 +01005 version 1.9
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau0b787922017-11-26 19:25:23 +01007 2017/11/26
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100595. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200110
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011110. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011210.1. Limitation
11310.2. Setup
11410.2.1. Cache section
11510.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116
1171. Quick reminder about HTTP
118----------------------------
119
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100120When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
122on almost anything found in the contents.
123
124However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
125formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
126correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
127
128
1291.1. The HTTP transaction model
130-------------------------------
131
132The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100133to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100134from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
135connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136will involve a new connection :
137
138 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
139
140In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
141establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
142by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
143length.
144
145Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
146to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
147however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
148response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
149header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
154power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
155but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200156a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100158Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
160second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
161page :
162
163 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
164
165This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
166latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
167correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
168the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100169server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100171The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
172time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
173are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
174parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
175carry the stream identifier.
176
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100177By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
178connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
179leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100180start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
181processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
182waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200183
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100184HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
185 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
186 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
187 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
188 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
189 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
190 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
191
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100192For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
193the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100194server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
195is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
196servers.
197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198
1991.2. HTTP request
200-----------------
201
202First, let's consider this HTTP request :
203
204 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100205 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
207 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
208 3 User-agent: my small browser
209 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
210 5 Accept: image/png
211
212
2131.2.1. The Request line
214-----------------------
215
216Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
217
218 - a METHOD : GET
219 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
220 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
221
222All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
223which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
224followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
225is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
226desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
227the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
228
229The URI itself can have several forms :
230
231 - A "relative URI" :
232
233 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234
235 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
236 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
237
238 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
239
240 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241
242 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
243 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
244 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
245 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
246 must accept this form too.
247
248 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
249 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
250 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200252 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
253 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
254 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
255 other protocols too.
256
257In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
258mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
259on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
260It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
261specific to the language, framework or application in use.
262
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100263HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100264assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100265However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
266received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
267processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
268as well as in server logs.
269
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200270
2711.2.2. The request headers
272--------------------------
273
274The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
275beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
276an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
277Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
278values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
279encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
280the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
281define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
282
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100283Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200284their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100285"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
286as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
288The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
289that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
290is one valid form of empty line.
291
292Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
293headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
294about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
295application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
296
297Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000298 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
300 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
301 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
302
303
3041.3. HTTP response
305------------------
306
307An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
308messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
309
310 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100311 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
313 2 Content-length: 350
314 3 Content-Type: text/html
315
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200316As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
317codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
318response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100319continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
320the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
321following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
322sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
323(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
324correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
325such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
326state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
327over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
328if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
329information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200331
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003321.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200333------------------------
334
335Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
336
337 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
338 - a status code : 200
339 - a reason : OK
340
341The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100342 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
343 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
344 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
345 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
346 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200347
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000348Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100349"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200350found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
351messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
352or "Authentication Required".
353
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200355
356 Code When / reason
357 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
358 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
359 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
360 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100361 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
362 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363 400 for an invalid or too large request
364 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
365 accessing the stats page)
366 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
367 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
368 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
369 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
370 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
371 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
372 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
373 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
374 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
375
376The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3774.2).
378
379
3801.3.2. The response headers
381---------------------------
382
383Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
384the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
385details.
386
387
3882. Configuring HAProxy
389----------------------
390
3912.1. Configuration file format
392------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200393
394HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
395
396 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
397 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
398 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
399 "frontend" and "backend".
400
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100401The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
402referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200403delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200405
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004062.2. Quoting and escaping
407-------------------------
408
409HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
410many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
411with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
412single quotes.
413
414If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
415them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
416escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
417
418Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
419
420 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
421 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
422 \\ to use a backslash
423 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
424 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
425
426Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
427the interpretation of:
428
429 space as a parameter separator
430 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
431 # hash as a comment start
432
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200433Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
434-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
435backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
436
437Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200438quoting.
439
440Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
441nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
442
443Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
444equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
445
446 Example:
447 # those are equivalents:
448 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
449 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
450 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
451 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
452 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
453
454 # those are equivalents:
455 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
456 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
458 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
459
460
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004612.3. Environment variables
462--------------------------
463
464HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
465interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
466configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
467optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
468shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
469underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
470
471 Example:
472
473 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
474
475 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
476
477 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
478
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200479A special variable $HAPROXY_LOCALPEER is defined at the startup of the process
480which contains the name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
481
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200482
4832.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200484----------------
485
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100486Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100487values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
488otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
489numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
490for every keyword. Supported units are :
491
492 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
493 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
494 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
495 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
496 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
497 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
498
499
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005002.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200501-------------
502
503 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
504 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
505 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
506 global
507 daemon
508 maxconn 256
509
510 defaults
511 mode http
512 timeout connect 5000ms
513 timeout client 50000ms
514 timeout server 50000ms
515
516 frontend http-in
517 bind *:80
518 default_backend servers
519
520 backend servers
521 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
522
523
524 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
525 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
526 global
527 daemon
528 maxconn 256
529
530 defaults
531 mode http
532 timeout connect 5000ms
533 timeout client 50000ms
534 timeout server 50000ms
535
536 listen http-in
537 bind *:80
538 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
539
540
541Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
542
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100543 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200544
545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005463. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547--------------------
548
549Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
550are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
551of them have command-line equivalents.
552
553The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
554
555 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200556 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200557 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200558 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200559 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200560 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200561 - description
562 - deviceatlas-json-file
563 - deviceatlas-log-level
564 - deviceatlas-separator
565 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900566 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200567 - gid
568 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100569 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200570 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200571 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100572 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200573 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200575 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200576 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100578 - presetenv
579 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200580 - uid
581 - ulimit-n
582 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100583 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200584 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200585 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
586 - ssl-default-bind-options
587 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
588 - ssl-default-server-options
589 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100590 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100591 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100592 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100593 - 51degrees-data-file
594 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200595 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200596 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100597 - wurfl-data-file
598 - wurfl-information-list
599 - wurfl-information-list-separator
600 - wurfl-engine-mode
601 - wurfl-cache-size
602 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100603
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200604 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200605 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200606 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200607 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100608 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100609 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100610 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200611 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200612 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200613 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200614 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200615 - noepoll
616 - nokqueue
617 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100618 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300619 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000620 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200621 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200622 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200623 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000624 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000625 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200626 - tune.buffers.limit
627 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200628 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200629 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100630 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200631 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200632 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200633 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100634 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200635 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200636 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100637 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100638 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100639 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100640 - tune.lua.session-timeout
641 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200642 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100643 - tune.maxaccept
644 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200645 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200646 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200647 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100648 - tune.rcvbuf.client
649 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100650 - tune.recv_enough
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100651 - tune.sndbuf.client
652 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100653 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100654 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200655 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100656 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200657 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200658 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100659 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200660 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100661 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200662 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
663 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
664 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100665 - tune.zlib.memlevel
666 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100667
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200668 * Debugging
669 - debug
670 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200671
672
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006733.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200674------------------------------------
675
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200676ca-base <dir>
677 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200678 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
679 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200680
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200681chroot <jail dir>
682 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
683 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
684 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
685 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
686 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100687 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100688
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100689cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
690 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
691 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
692 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
693 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
694 set. These sets have the format
695
696 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
697
698 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100699 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100700 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
701 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100702 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
703 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100704 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100705 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100706 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100707 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100708 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
709 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
710 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
711 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100712
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100713 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
714 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
715 on the machine's word size.
716
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100717 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100718 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
719 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
720 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
721 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
722 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
723 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100724
725 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100726 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
727
728 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
729 # first 4 CPUs
730
731 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
732 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
733 # word size.
734
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100735 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100736 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100737 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
738 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
739 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
740
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100741 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
742 # and so on.
743 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
744 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
745 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
746
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100747 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100748 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
749 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
750 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
751
752 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
753 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
754 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
755
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100756 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
757 # and a thread range.
758 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
759 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
760 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
761
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200762crt-base <dir>
763 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
764 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
765 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
766
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200767daemon
768 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
769 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100770 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
771 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200772
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200773deviceatlas-json-file <path>
774 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100775 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200776
777deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100778 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200779 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
780
781deviceatlas-separator <char>
782 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
783 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
784
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100785deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200786 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
787 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
788 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100789
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900790external-check
791 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
792 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
793 See "option external-check".
794
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200795gid <number>
796 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
797 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
798 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100799 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
800 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200801 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100802
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100803hard-stop-after <time>
804 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
805
806 Arguments :
807 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
808 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
809 SIGUSR1 signal.
810
811 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
812 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
813 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
814
815 Example:
816 global
817 hard-stop-after 30s
818
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200819group <group name>
820 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
821 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100822
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200823log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100824 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100825 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100826 configured with "log global".
827
828 <address> can be one of:
829
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100830 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100831 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
832 port).
833
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100834 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
835 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
836 port).
837
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100838 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
839 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
840 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100841 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100842
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200843 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
844 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100845
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200846 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
847 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
848 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
849 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
850 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
851 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
852 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
853 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
854 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
855 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100856 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
857 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200858
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200859 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
860 one of the following :
861
862 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
863 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
864
865 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
866 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
867
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100868 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200869
870 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
871 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
872 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
873
874 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200875 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
876 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
877 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
878 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
879 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
880 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200881
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200882 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200883
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100884log-send-hostname [<string>]
885 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
886 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
887 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
888 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
889 the logs.
890
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000891log-tag <string>
892 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
893 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
894 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100895 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000896
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100897lua-load <file>
898 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
899 used multiple times.
900
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100901master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200902 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
903 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
904 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100905 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200906 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
907 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100908 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
909 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
910 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
911 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
912 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200913
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100914 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200915
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200916nbproc <number>
917 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
918 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
919 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
920 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
921 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
922
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200923nbthread <number>
924 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
925 creates <number> threads for each created processes. It means if HAProxy is
926 started in foreground, it only creates <number> threads for the first
927 process. FOR NOW, THREADS SUPPORT IN HAPROXY IS HIGHLY EXPERIMENTAL AND IT
928 MUST BE ENABLED WITH CAUTION AND AT YOUR OWN RISK. See also "nbproc".
929
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200930pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100931 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200932 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
933 starting the process. See also "daemon".
934
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100935presetenv <name> <value>
936 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
937 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
938 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
939 and "unsetenv".
940
941resetenv [<name> ...]
942 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
943 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
944 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
945 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
946 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
947 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
948 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
949 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
950
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100951stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200952 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
953 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
954 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
955 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
956 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
957 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100958 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100959 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
960 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
961 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
962 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200963
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200964server-state-base <directory>
965 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200966 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
967 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200968
969server-state-file <file>
970 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
971 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
972 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
973 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
974 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
975 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
976 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
977 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200978 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
979 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200980
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100981setenv <name> <value>
982 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
983 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
984 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
985 and "unsetenv".
986
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100987ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
988 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
989 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300990 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100991 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
992 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
993 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
994 "bind" keyword for more information.
995
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100996ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
997 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
998 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
999 keyword to see available options.
1000
1001 Example:
1002 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001003 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001004
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001005ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1006 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1007 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001008 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001009 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
1010 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
1011 information.
1012
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001013ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1014 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1015 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1016 keyword to see available options.
1017
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001018ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1019 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1020 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1021 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001022 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001023 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001024 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1025 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1026 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1027 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001028 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1029 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1030 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1031
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001032ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1033 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1034 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1035 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1036
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001037stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1038 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1039 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1040 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001041 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001042 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001043
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001044 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1045 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1046 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001047
1048stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1049 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1050 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001051 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001052
1053stats maxconn <connections>
1054 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1055 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1056
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001057uid <number>
1058 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1059 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1060 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1061 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1062
1063ulimit-n <number>
1064 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1065 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1066 option.
1067
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001068unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1069 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1070
1071 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1072 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1073 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1074 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1075 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1076 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1077 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1078 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1079 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1080 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1081
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001082unsetenv [<name> ...]
1083 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1084 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1085 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1086 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1087 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1088 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1089 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1090
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001091user <user name>
1092 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1093 See also "uid" and "group".
1094
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001095node <name>
1096 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1097
1098 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1099 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1100 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1101 traffic.
1102
1103description <text>
1104 Add a text that describes the instance.
1105
1106 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1107 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1108 "<" and ">" characters.
1109
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100111051degrees-data-file <file path>
1111 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001112 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001113
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001114 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001115 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1116
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000111751degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001118 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1119 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1120 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1121
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001122 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001123 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1124
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200112551degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001126 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1127 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1128
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001129 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1130 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1131
113251degrees-cache-size <number>
1133 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1134 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1135 By default, this cache is disabled.
1136
1137 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001138 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1139
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001140wurfl-data-file <file path>
1141 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1142 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1143
1144 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1145 with USE_WURFL=1.
1146
1147wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1148 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1149 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1150 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1151
1152 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1153
1154 Valid WURFL properties are:
1155 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1156
1157 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1158 device.
1159
1160 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1161 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1162
1163 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1164 particular web request.
1165
1166 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1167 used Libwurfl API version.
1168
1169 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1170 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1171 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1172
1173 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1174 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1175
1176 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1177 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1178
1179 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1180
1181 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1182
1183 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1184 with USE_WURFL=1.
1185
1186wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1187 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1188 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1189
1190 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1191 with USE_WURFL=1.
1192
1193wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1194 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1195 thus before the chroot.
1196
1197 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1198 with USE_WURFL=1.
1199
1200wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1201 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1202 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001203 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001204 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001205 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001206 mode is enabled by default.
1207
1208 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1209 with USE_WURFL=1.
1210
1211wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1212 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1213 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1214 - "0" : no cache is used.
1215 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1216 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1217 the highest performing option.
1218
1219 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1220 with USE_WURFL=1.
1221
1222wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1223 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1224 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1225
1226 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1227 with USE_WURFL=1.
1228
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001229
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012303.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001231-----------------------
1232
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001233max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1234 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1235 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1236 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1237 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1238 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1239 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1240 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1241 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1242
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001243maxconn <number>
1244 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1245 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1246 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001247 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1248 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1249 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1250 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001251 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1252 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1253 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1254 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1255 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001256
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001257maxconnrate <number>
1258 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1259 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1260 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1261 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1262 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1263 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1264 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1265 fairness.
1266
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001267maxcomprate <number>
1268 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001269 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001270 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1271 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1272 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001273 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001274 default value.
1275
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001276maxcompcpuusage <number>
1277 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1278 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1279 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1280 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1281 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1282 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1283 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1284 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1285
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001286maxpipes <number>
1287 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1288 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1289 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1290 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1291 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1292 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1293
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001294maxsessrate <number>
1295 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1296 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1297 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1298 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1299 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1300 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1301 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1302 fairness.
1303
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001304maxsslconn <number>
1305 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1306 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1307 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1308 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1309 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1310 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1311 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001312 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1313 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1314 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1315 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1316 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1317 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1318 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001319
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001320maxsslrate <number>
1321 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1322 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1323 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1324 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1325 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1326 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1327 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1328 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1329 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1330 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1331
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001332maxzlibmem <number>
1333 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1334 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1335 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001336 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1337 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1338 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1339
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001340noepoll
1341 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1342 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001343 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001344
1345nokqueue
1346 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1347 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1348 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1349
1350nopoll
1351 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1352 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001353 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001354 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001355
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001356nosplice
1357 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001358 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001359 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001360 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001361 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1362 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1363 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1364 "option splice-response".
1365
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001366nogetaddrinfo
1367 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1368 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1369
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001370noreuseport
1371 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1372 command line argument "-dR".
1373
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001374spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001375 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1376 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1377 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1378 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1379 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1380 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001381
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001382ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001383 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001384 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001385 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1386 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1387 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1388 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1389 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001390 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1391 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001392 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1393 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1394 openssl configuration file uses:
1395 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1396
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001397ssl-mode-async
1398 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001399 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001400 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1401 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1402 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
1403 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and reneg
1404 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001405
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001406tune.buffers.limit <number>
1407 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1408 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1409 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1410 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1411 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001412 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001413 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1414 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1415 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1416 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1417 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1418 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1419 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1420 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1421 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1422
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001423tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1424 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1425 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1426 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1427 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1428
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001429tune.bufsize <number>
1430 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1431 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1432 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1433 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1434 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1435 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1436 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001437 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1438 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1439 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001440 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1441 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001442
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001443tune.chksize <number>
1444 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1445 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1446 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1447 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1448 checks whenever possible.
1449
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001450tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1451 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1452 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1453 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1454 this value. The default value is 1.
1455
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001456tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1457 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1458 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1459 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1460 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1461 change it.
1462
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001463tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1464 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001465 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1466 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001467 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1468 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1469 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1470 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1471 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1472
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001473tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1474 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1475 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1476 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1477 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1478 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1479 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1480 recommended not to change this value.
1481
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001482tune.http.cookielen <number>
1483 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1484 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1485 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1486 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1487 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1488 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1489 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1490 to change this value.
1491
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001492tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001493 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1494 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001495 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001496 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001497 configuration directives too.
1498 The default value is 1024.
1499
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001500tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1501 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1502 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1503 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1504 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1505 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1506 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001507 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1508 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1509 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001510
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001511tune.idletimer <timeout>
1512 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1513 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1514 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1515 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1516 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1517 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001518 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001519 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1520 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1521
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001522tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1523 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001524 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001525 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1526 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001527 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001528 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1529 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1530
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001531tune.lua.maxmem
1532 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1533 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1534 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1535 memory.
1536
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001537tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1538 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001539 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1540 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001541 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001542
1543tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1544 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1545 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1546 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1547 check servers.
1548
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001549tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1550 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1551 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1552 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001553 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001554
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001555tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001556 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1557 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1558 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1559 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1560 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1561 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1562 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1563 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1564 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1565 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001566
1567tune.maxpollevents <number>
1568 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1569 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1570 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1571 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1572 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1573
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001574tune.maxrewrite <number>
1575 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1576 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1577 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1578 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1579 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1580 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1581 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1582 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1583 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1584 bufsize.
1585
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001586tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1587 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1588 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1589 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1590 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1591 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1592 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1593 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1594 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1595 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1596 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1597 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1598 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1599 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1600 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1601 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1602 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1603 setting this parameter to 0.
1604
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001605tune.pipesize <number>
1606 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1607 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1608 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1609 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1610 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1611 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1612
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001613tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1614tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1615 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1616 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1617 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1618 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001619 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001620 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1621 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1622
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001623tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001624 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001625 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1626 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1627 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1628 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1629
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001630tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1631tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1632 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1633 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1634 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1635 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001636 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001637 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1638 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1639 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1640 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1641 notifying haproxy again.
1642
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001643tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001644 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1645 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1646 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001647 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001648 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001649 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001650 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1651 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1652 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001653 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1654 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001655
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001656tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1657 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1658 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1659 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1660 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1661 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1662 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1663
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001664tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1665 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001666 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001667 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1668 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1669 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1670 being used for too long.
1671
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001672tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1673 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1674 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1675 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1676 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1677 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1678 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1679 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1680 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1681 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1682 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001683 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001684 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001685
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001686tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1687 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1688 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1689 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1690 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1691 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1692 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1693 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001694 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1695 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001696
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001697tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1698 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1699 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1700 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1701 1000 entries.
1702
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001703tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1704 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1705 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1706 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1707
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001708tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001709tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001710tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1711tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1712tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001713 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1714 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1715 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1716 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1717 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1718 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1719 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1720 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001721
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001722 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1723 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1724 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1725 all available space is consumed.
1726 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1727 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1728 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001729
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001730tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1731 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001732 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001733 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001734 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001735 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1736
1737tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1738 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1739 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001740 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1741 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001742
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017433.3. Debugging
1744--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001745
1746debug
1747 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1748 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1749 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1750 system startup.
1751
1752quiet
1753 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1754 line argument "-q".
1755
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001756
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010017573.4. Userlists
1758--------------
1759It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1760http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1761it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1762
1763userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001764 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001765 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1766
1767group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001768 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001769 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1770 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1771
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001772user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1773 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001774 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1775 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001776 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
1777 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
1778 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
1779 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001780
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001781 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
1782 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
1783 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
1784 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
1785 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
1786 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
1787 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
1788 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
1789 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001790
1791 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001792 userlist L1
1793 group G1 users tiger,scott
1794 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001795
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001796 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1797 user scott insecure-password elgato
1798 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001799
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001800 userlist L2
1801 group G1
1802 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001803
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001804 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1805 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1806 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001807
1808 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001809
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001810
18113.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001812----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001813It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1814several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1815instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1816values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1817automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1818In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1819using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1820tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1821reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1822Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1823that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1824each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001825
1826peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001827 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001828 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1829
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001830disabled
1831 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1832 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1833 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1834
1835enable
1836 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1837
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001838peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1839 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1840 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1841 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1842 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1843 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1844 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1845
1846 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1847 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1848
1849 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1850 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1851 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1852 across all peers.
1853
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001854 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1855 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001856
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001857 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001858 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001859 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1860 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1861 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001862
1863 backend mybackend
1864 mode tcp
1865 balance roundrobin
1866 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1867 stick on src
1868
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001869 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1870 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001871
1872
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090018733.6. Mailers
1874------------
1875It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1876If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1877in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1878
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001879mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001880 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1881 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1882
1883mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1884 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1885
1886 Example:
1887 mailers mymailers
1888 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1889 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1890
1891 backend mybackend
1892 mode tcp
1893 balance roundrobin
1894
1895 email-alert mailers mymailers
1896 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1897 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1898
1899 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1900 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1901
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001902timeout mail <time>
1903 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1904 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1905 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1906 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1907
1908 Example:
1909 mailers mymailers
1910 timeout mail 20s
1911 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001912
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019134. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001914----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001915
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001916Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001917 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001918 - frontend <name>
1919 - backend <name>
1920 - listen <name>
1921
1922A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1923its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1924section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001925section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001926
1927A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1928connections.
1929
1930A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1931to forward incoming connections.
1932
1933A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1934parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1935
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001936All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1937'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1938case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1939
1940Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1941logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1942proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1943However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1944name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1945
1946Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1947and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001948bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001949protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1950modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1951arbitrary criteria.
1952
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001953In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1954a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1955the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1956
1957 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1958 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1959 between responses and new requests.
1960
1961 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1962 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1963 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1964 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1965
1966 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1967 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1968 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1969
1970 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1971 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1972 client-facing connection remains open.
1973
1974 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1975 after the end of the response.
1976
1977The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1978frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1979following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1980weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1981
1982 Backend mode
1983
1984 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1985 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1986 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1987 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1988 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1989 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1990 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1991 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1992 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1993 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1994 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1995
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001996
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001997
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019984.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1999--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002000
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002001The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2002limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2003they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2004limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002005marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002006option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002007and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2008with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2009specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002010
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002011
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002012 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2013------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2014acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002015appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002016backlog X X X -
2017balance X - X X
2018bind - X X -
2019bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002020block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002021capture cookie - X X -
2022capture request header - X X -
2023capture response header - X X -
2024clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002025compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002026contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2027cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002028declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002029default-server X - X X
2030default_backend X X X -
2031description - X X X
2032disabled X X X X
2033dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002034email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002035email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002036email-alert mailers X X X X
2037email-alert myhostname X X X X
2038email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002039enabled X X X X
2040errorfile X X X X
2041errorloc X X X X
2042errorloc302 X X X X
2043-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2044errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002045force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002046filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002047fullconn X - X X
2048grace X X X X
2049hash-type X - X X
2050http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002051http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002052http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002053http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002054http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002055http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002056http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002057id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002058ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002059load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002060log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002061log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002062log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002063log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002064max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002065maxconn X X X -
2066mode X X X X
2067monitor fail - X X -
2068monitor-net X X X -
2069monitor-uri X X X -
2070option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2071option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2072option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2073option allbackups (*) X - X X
2074option checkcache (*) X - X X
2075option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2076option contstats (*) X X X -
2077option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2078option dontlognull (*) X X X -
2079option forceclose (*) X X X X
2080-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2081option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002082option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002083option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002084option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002085option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02002086option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002087option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01002088option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002089option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2090option httpchk X - X X
2091option httpclose (*) X X X X
2092option httplog X X X X
2093option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002094option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002095option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002096option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002097option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2098option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2099option logasap (*) X X X -
2100option mysql-check X - X X
2101option nolinger (*) X X X X
2102option originalto X X X X
2103option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002104option pgsql-check X - X X
2105option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002106option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002107option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002108option smtpchk X - X X
2109option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2110option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2111option splice-request (*) X X X X
2112option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002113option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002114option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2115option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2116-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002117option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002118option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2119option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2120option tcpka X X X X
2121option tcplog X X X X
2122option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002123external-check command X - X X
2124external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002125persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2126rate-limit sessions X X X -
2127redirect - X X X
2128redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2129redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
2130reqadd - X X X
2131reqallow - X X X
2132reqdel - X X X
2133reqdeny - X X X
2134reqiallow - X X X
2135reqidel - X X X
2136reqideny - X X X
2137reqipass - X X X
2138reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002139reqitarpit - X X X
2140reqpass - X X X
2141reqrep - X X X
2142-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002143reqtarpit - X X X
2144retries X - X X
2145rspadd - X X X
2146rspdel - X X X
2147rspdeny - X X X
2148rspidel - X X X
2149rspideny - X X X
2150rspirep - X X X
2151rsprep - X X X
2152server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002153server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002154server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002155source X - X X
2156srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002157stats admin - X X X
2158stats auth X X X X
2159stats enable X X X X
2160stats hide-version X X X X
2161stats http-request - X X X
2162stats realm X X X X
2163stats refresh X X X X
2164stats scope X X X X
2165stats show-desc X X X X
2166stats show-legends X X X X
2167stats show-node X X X X
2168stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002169-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2170stick match - - X X
2171stick on - - X X
2172stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002173stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002174stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002175tcp-check connect - - X X
2176tcp-check expect - - X X
2177tcp-check send - - X X
2178tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002179tcp-request connection - X X -
2180tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002181tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002182tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002183tcp-response content - - X X
2184tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002185timeout check X - X X
2186timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002187timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002188timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2189timeout connect X - X X
2190timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2191timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2192timeout http-request X X X X
2193timeout queue X - X X
2194timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002195timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002196timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2197timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002198timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002199transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002200unique-id-format X X X -
2201unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002202use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002203use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002204------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2205 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002206
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002207
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022084.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2209---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002210
2211This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2212
2213
2214acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2215 Declare or complete an access list.
2216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2217 no | yes | yes | yes
2218 Example:
2219 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2220 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2221 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2222
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002223 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002224
2225
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002226appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2227 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002228 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2230 no | no | yes | yes
2231 Arguments :
2232 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2233 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2234
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002235 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002236 checked in each cookie value.
2237
2238 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2239 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2240 milliseconds.
2241
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002242 request-learn
2243 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2244 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2245 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2246 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2247 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2248 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2249
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002250 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2251 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2252 data following this prefix.
2253
2254 Example :
2255 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2256
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002257 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXX=XXXX,
2258 the appsession value will be XXX=XXXX.
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002259
2260 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2261 2 modes are currently supported :
2262 - path-parameters :
2263 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2264 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2265 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2266 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2267 - query-string :
2268 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2269 query string.
2270
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002271 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2272 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2273 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002274
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002275 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2276 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002277
2278
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002279backlog <conns>
2280 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2282 yes | yes | yes | no
2283 Arguments :
2284 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2285 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002286 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002287
2288 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2289 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2290 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2291 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2292 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2293 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2294 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2295 backlog parameter.
2296
2297 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2298 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2299 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2300
2301 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2302
2303
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002304balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002305balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002306 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2308 yes | no | yes | yes
2309 Arguments :
2310 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2311 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2312 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2313 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2314
2315 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2316 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2317 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2318 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002319 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002320 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002321 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2322 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2323 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2324 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2325 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2326 it, so that you don't worry.
2327
2328 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2329 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2330 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2331 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2332 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2333 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2334 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2335 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002336
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002337 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2338 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2339 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2340 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2341 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2342 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2343 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2344 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2345
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002346 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002347 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002348 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2349 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002350 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002351 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2352 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2353 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2354 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2355 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002356 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2357 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2358 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2359 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2360 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2361 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002362
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002363 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2364 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2365 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2366 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2367 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2368 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2369 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2370 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002371 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002372 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002373 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2374 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2375 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002376
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002377 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2378 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2379 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2380 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2381 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2382 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2383 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2384 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2385 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2386 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2387 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2388 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002389
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002390 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002391 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2392 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2393 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2394 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2395 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2396 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2397 URIs start with a leading "/".
2398
2399 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2400 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2401 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2402 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2403
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002404 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002405 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2406
2407 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002408 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2409 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002410 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2411 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2412 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2413 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002414 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002415 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2416 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002417
2418 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2419 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2420 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2421 server will receive the request.
2422
2423 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2424 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2425 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2426 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2427 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002428 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2429 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2430 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002431
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002432 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2433 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2434 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2435 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2436 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002437
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002438 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002439 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2440 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2441 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2442
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002443 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2444 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2445 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2446
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002447 random A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
2448 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2449 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2450 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2451 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
2452 or removed. The hash-balance-factor directive can be used to
2453 further improve fairness of the load balancing, especially
2454 in situations where servers show highly variable response
2455 times.
2456
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002457 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002458 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002459 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2460 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2461 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2462 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2463 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2464 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002465 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002466 used instead.
2467
2468 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2469 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2470 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2471 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2472
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002473 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2474 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2475 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2476
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002477 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002478
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002479 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002480 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2481 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002482
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002483 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2484 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2485 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002486
2487 Examples :
2488 balance roundrobin
2489 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002490 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002491 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2492 balance hdr(host)
2493 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002494
2495 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2496 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2497
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002498 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002499 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2500 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2501 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2502 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2503
2504 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2505 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2506 defaults to 16 kB.
2507
2508 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2509 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2510
2511 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2512 Round Robin.
2513
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002514 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002515 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2516 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2517 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2518
2519 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2520
2521 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002522 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002523 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2524 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2525 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002526
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002527 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002528
2529
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002530bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2531bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002532 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2534 no | yes | yes | no
2535 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002536 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2537 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2538 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2539 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002540 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002541 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2542 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2543 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2544 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2545 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2546 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2547 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002548 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2549 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2550 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2551 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2552 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2553 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2554 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002555 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2556 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2557 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002558 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2559 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2560 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002561
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002562 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2563 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002564 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2565 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2566 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002567 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2568 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2569 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2570 the range.
2571
2572 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2573 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2574 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2575 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2576 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2577 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2578 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002579 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002580 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002581
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002582 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002583 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002584 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2585 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2586 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2587 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2588 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2589 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2590
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002591 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2592 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2593 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2594 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002595
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002596 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2597 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2598 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2599 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2600 in a frontend.
2601
2602 Example :
2603 listen http_proxy
2604 bind :80,:443
2605 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002606 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002607
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002608 listen http_https_proxy
2609 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002610 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002611
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002612 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2613 bind ipv6@:80
2614 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2615 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2616
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002617 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002618 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002619
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002620 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2621 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2622 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2623 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2624 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2625
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002626 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002627 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002628
2629
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002630bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002631 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2633 yes | yes | yes | yes
2634 Arguments :
2635 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2636 may be used to override a default value.
2637
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002638 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002639 option may be combined with other numbers.
2640
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002641 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002642 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2643 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2644 missing from all processes.
2645
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002646 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002647 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002648 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
2649 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
2650 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
2651 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
2652 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002653 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002654
2655 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2656 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2657 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2658 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2659 and 'even' instances.
2660
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002661 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2662 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2663 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2664 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002665
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002666 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2667 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2668
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002669 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2670 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2671 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2672
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002673 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2674 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2675
2676 Example :
2677 listen app_ip1
2678 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002679 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002680
2681 listen app_ip2
2682 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002683 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002684
2685 listen management
2686 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002687 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002688
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002689 listen management
2690 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2691 bind-process 1-4
2692
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002693 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002694
2695
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002696block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002697 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2699 no | yes | yes | yes
2700
2701 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2702 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002703 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002704 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002705 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002706 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2707 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2708 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002709
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002710 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2711 "http-request deny" instead.
2712
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002713 Example:
2714 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2715 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2716 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002717 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2718 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2719 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002720
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002721 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2722 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2723 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002724
2725capture cookie <name> len <length>
2726 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2727 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2728 no | yes | yes | no
2729 Arguments :
2730 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2731 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2732 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2733 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002734 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002735
2736 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2737 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2738 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2739 right if it exceeds <length>.
2740
2741 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2742 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2743 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2744 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2745
2746 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2747 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2748 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2749
2750 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2751 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2752 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002753 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2754 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2755 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002756
2757 Example:
2758 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2759
2760 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002761 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002762
2763
2764capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002765 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2767 no | yes | yes | no
2768 Arguments :
2769 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002770 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002771 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2772 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2773 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2774
2775 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2776 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2777 it exceeds <length>.
2778
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002779 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002780 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2781 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002782 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2783 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2784 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2785 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002786 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002787 environments to find where the request came from.
2788
2789 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2790 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2791 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2792 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002793
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002794 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2795 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2796 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2797 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2798 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002799
2800 Example:
2801 capture request header Host len 15
2802 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002803 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002804
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002805 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002806 about logging.
2807
2808
2809capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002810 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2812 no | yes | yes | no
2813 Arguments :
2814 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002815 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002816 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2817 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2818 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2819
2820 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2821 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2822 it exceeds <length>.
2823
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002824 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002825 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2826 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2827 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002828 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2829 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2830 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2831 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002832
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002833 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2834 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2835 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2836 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2837 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002838
2839 Example:
2840 capture response header Content-length len 9
2841 capture response header Location len 15
2842
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002843 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002844 about logging.
2845
2846
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002847clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002848 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2850 yes | yes | yes | no
2851 Arguments :
2852 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2853 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2854 as explained at the top of this document.
2855
2856 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2857 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2858 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2859 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2860 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2861 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2862 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2863 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002864 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002865 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002866 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002867
2868 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2869 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2870 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2871 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2872 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2873 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2874
2875 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2876 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2877
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002878 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2879 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002880
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002881compression algo <algorithm> ...
2882compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002883compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002884 Enable HTTP compression.
2885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2886 yes | yes | yes | yes
2887 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002888 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2889 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2890 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2891
2892 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002893 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2894 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2895 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002896
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002897 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002898 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002899
2900 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2901 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2902 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2903 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2904 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002905 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002906
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002907 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2908 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2909 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2910 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2911 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2912 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2913 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002914 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002915
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002916 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002917 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002918 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2919 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2920 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2921 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2922 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002923
2924 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2925 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2926 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2927 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2928 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002929 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2930 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2931 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2932 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2933 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002934 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2935 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002936
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002937 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002938 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2939 "Accept-Encoding" header
2940 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002941 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002942 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2943 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002944 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2945 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2946 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2947 "multipart"
2948 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2949 header
2950 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2951 and later
2952 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2953 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002954
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002955 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2956 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002957
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002958 Examples :
2959 compression algo gzip
2960 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002961
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002962
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002963contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002964 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2966 yes | no | yes | yes
2967 Arguments :
2968 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2969 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2970 as explained at the top of this document.
2971
2972 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002973 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002974 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002975 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002976 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2977 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2978 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2979
2980 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2981 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2982 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2983 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2984 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2985 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2986
2987 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2988 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2989 instead.
2990
2991 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2992 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2993
2994
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002995cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002996 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2997 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01002998 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002999 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3001 yes | no | yes | yes
3002 Arguments :
3003 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3004 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3005 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3006 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3007 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3008 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003009 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003010 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3011 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3012
3013 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3014 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3015 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3016 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3017 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3018 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003019 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3020 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003021 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003022 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3023 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003024
3025 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003026 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003027
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003028 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003029 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
3030 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003031 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003032 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3033 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3034 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3035 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3036 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3037 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3038 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003039
3040 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3041 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3042 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3043 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3044 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3045 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3046 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3047 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3048 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003049 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003050 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3051 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3052 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003053
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003054 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3055 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3056 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003057 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3058 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3059 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3060 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003061 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3062 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3063 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003064
3065 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3066 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3067 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3068 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3069 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3070 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3071 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3072 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3073 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3074
3075 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3076 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3077 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3078 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3079 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3080 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3081 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3082 persistence cookie in the cache.
3083 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3084
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003085 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3086 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3087 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3088 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3089 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003090 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003091 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3092 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3093 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3094 they logout.
3095
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003096 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3097 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3098 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3099 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3100
3101 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3102 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3103 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3104 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3105 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3106 this attribute.
3107
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003108 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003109 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003110 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3111 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3112 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3113 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3114 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3115 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003116
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003117 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3118 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3119 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3120 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3121 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3122 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3123 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3124 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003125 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003126 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3127 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3128 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3129 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3130 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3131 the site.
3132
3133 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3134 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3135 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3136 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3137 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3138 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3139 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3140 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3141 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3142 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3143 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3144 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3145 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003146 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003147 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3148 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3149
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003150 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3151 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3152 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3153 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3154 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3155 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3156
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003157 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3158 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3159 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3160 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003161
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003162 Examples :
3163 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3164 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3165 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003166 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003167
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003168 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003169
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003170
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003171declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3172 Declares a capture slot.
3173 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3174 no | yes | yes | no
3175 Arguments:
3176 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3177
3178 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3179 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3180 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3181 for use in the response.
3182
3183 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003184 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003185 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3186
3187
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003188default-server [param*]
3189 Change default options for a server in a backend
3190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3191 yes | no | yes | yes
3192 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003193 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3194 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3195 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3196 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003197
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003198 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003199 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3200
3201 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003202
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003203
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003204default_backend <backend>
3205 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3207 yes | yes | yes | no
3208 Arguments :
3209 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3210
3211 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3212 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3213 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3214 will catch all undetermined requests.
3215
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003216 Example :
3217
3218 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3219 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3220 default_backend dynamic
3221
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003222 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003223
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003224
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003225description <string>
3226 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3228 no | yes | yes | yes
3229 Arguments : string
3230
3231 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3232 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3233 it describes.
3234 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3235
3236
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003237disabled
3238 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3240 yes | yes | yes | yes
3241 Arguments : none
3242
3243 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3244 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3245 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3246 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3247 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3248 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3249 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3250
3251 See also : "enabled"
3252
3253
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003254dispatch <address>:<port>
3255 Set a default server address
3256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3257 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003258 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003259
3260 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3261 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3262 during start-up.
3263
3264 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3265 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3266 possible with normal servers.
3267
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003268 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003269 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3270 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3271 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3272 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3273
3274 See also : "server"
3275
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003276
3277dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3278 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3279 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3280 yes | no | yes | yes
3281 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3282
3283 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003284 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003285 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3286 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003287 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003288 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003289
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003290enabled
3291 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3293 yes | yes | yes | yes
3294 Arguments : none
3295
3296 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3297 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3298
3299 See also : "disabled"
3300
3301
3302errorfile <code> <file>
3303 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3305 yes | yes | yes | yes
3306 Arguments :
3307 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003308 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3309 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003310
3311 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003312 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003313 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003314 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3315 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003316
3317 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3318 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3319 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3320
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003321 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3322
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003323 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3324 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3325 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3326 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3327
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003328 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3329 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003330 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003331 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3332 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3333 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3334
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003335 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3336 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3337 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003338 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003339 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3340
3341 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3342
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003343 Example :
3344 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003345 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003346 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3347 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3348
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003349
3350errorloc <code> <url>
3351errorloc302 <code> <url>
3352 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3354 yes | yes | yes | yes
3355 Arguments :
3356 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003357 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3358 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003359
3360 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3361 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3362 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3363 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003364 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003365
3366 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3367 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3368 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3369
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003370 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3371
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003372 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3373 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3374 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3375 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003376 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003377 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3378 request.
3379
3380 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3381
3382
3383errorloc303 <code> <url>
3384 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3386 yes | yes | yes | yes
3387 Arguments :
3388 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003389 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3390 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003391
3392 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3393 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3394 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3395 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003396 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003397
3398 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3399 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3400 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3401
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003402 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3403
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003404 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3405 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3406 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3407 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003408 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003409
3410 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3411
3412
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003413email-alert from <emailaddr>
3414 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003415 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003416 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3417 yes | yes | yes | yes
3418
3419 Arguments :
3420
3421 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3422
3423 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3424 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3425
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003426 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003427 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3428 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003429
3430
3431email-alert level <level>
3432 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3433 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3434 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3435 yes | yes | yes | yes
3436
3437 Arguments :
3438
3439 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3440 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3441 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3442
3443 By default level is alert
3444
3445 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3446 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3447 for the proxy.
3448
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003449 Alerts are sent when :
3450
3451 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3452 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3453 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3454 is notice or lower
3455 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3456 and a health check status update occurs
3457
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003458 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3459 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003460 section 3.6 about mailers.
3461
3462
3463email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3464 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3465 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3466 yes | yes | yes | yes
3467
3468 Arguments :
3469
3470 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3471
3472 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3473 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3474
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003475 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3476 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003477
3478
3479email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3480 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3481 mailers.
3482 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3483 yes | yes | yes | yes
3484
3485 Arguments :
3486
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003487 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003488
3489 By default the systems hostname is used.
3490
3491 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3492 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3493 for the proxy.
3494
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003495 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3496 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003497
3498
3499email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003500 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003501 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3502 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3503 yes | yes | yes | yes
3504
3505 Arguments :
3506
3507 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3508
3509 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3510 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3511
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003512 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003513 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3514
3515
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003516force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3517 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3518 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003519 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003520
3521 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3522 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3523 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3524 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3525 marked down for maintenance operations.
3526
3527 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3528 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3529 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3530 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3531 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3532 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3533 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3534 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3535 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3536
3537 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3538 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3539 is used.
3540
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003541 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003542 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003543
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003544
3545filter <name> [param*]
3546 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3548 no | yes | yes | yes
3549 Arguments :
3550 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3551 referenced in section 9.
3552
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003553 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003554 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003555 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3556 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003557
3558 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3559 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3560
3561 Example:
3562 listen
3563 bind *:80
3564
3565 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3566 filter compression
3567 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3568
3569 compression algo gzip
3570 compression offload
3571
3572 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3573
3574 See also : section 9.
3575
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003576
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003577fullconn <conns>
3578 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3580 yes | no | yes | yes
3581 Arguments :
3582 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3583 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3584
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003585 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003586 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003587 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003588 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3589 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3590 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3591 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3592 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003593 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003594
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003595 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3596 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003597 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3598 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3599 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003600
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003601 Example :
3602 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3603 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3604 # connections.
3605 backend dynamic
3606 fullconn 10000
3607 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3608 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3609
3610 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3611
3612
3613grace <time>
3614 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3615 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003616 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003617 Arguments :
3618 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3619 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3620 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3621
3622 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3623 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003624 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003625 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3626
3627 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3628 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3629 simplify it.
3630
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003631
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003632hash-balance-factor <factor>
3633 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3635 yes | no | no | yes
3636 Arguments :
3637 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3638 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3639 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3640
3641 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3642 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3643 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3644 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3645 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3646 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3647 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3648
3649 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3650 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3651 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3652 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3653 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3654
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003655 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3656 consistent hashing mechanism.
3657
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003658 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3659
3660
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003661hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003662 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3664 yes | no | yes | yes
3665 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003666 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3667 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003668
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003669 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3670 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3671 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3672 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3673 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3674 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3675 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3676 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3677 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3678 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003679
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003680 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3681 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3682 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3683 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3684 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3685 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3686 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3687 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3688 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3689 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3690 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3691 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3692 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003693 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3694 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003695
3696 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3697
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003698 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003699 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3700 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3701 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003702 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3703 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3704 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003705
3706 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3707 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003708 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3709 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3710 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3711 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3712
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003713 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3714 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3715 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3716 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3717 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3718 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3719 parameter.
3720
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003721 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3722 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3723 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3724 used on strings.
3725
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003726 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3727
3728 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3729 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3730 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3731 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3732 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3733 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3734 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3735 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3736 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3737 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3738 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3739 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003740
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003741 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3742 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3743 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003744
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003745 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003746
3747
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003748http-check disable-on-404
3749 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003751 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003752 Arguments : none
3753
3754 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3755 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3756 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3757 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3758 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3759 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3760 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3761 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003762 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3763 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3764 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3765
3766 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3767
3768
3769http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003770 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003771 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003772 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003773 Arguments :
3774 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3775 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003776 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003777 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3778 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3779 details on the supported keywords.
3780
3781 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3782 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3783 with the usual backslash ('\').
3784
3785 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3786 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3787 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3788 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3789 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3790
3791 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003792 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003793 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3794 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3795 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3796
3797 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003798 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003799 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3800 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3801 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3802 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3803
3804 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003805 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003806 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3807 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3808 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3809 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3810 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003811 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003812 trace).
3813
3814 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003815 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003816 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3817 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3818 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3819 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3820 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003821 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003822
3823 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3824 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3825 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3826 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3827 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3828 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3829 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3830 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3831
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003832 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3833 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3834 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3835
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003836 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3837 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3838
3839 Examples :
3840 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003841 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003842
3843 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003844 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003845
3846 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003847 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003848
3849 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03003850 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003851
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003852 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003853
3854
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003855http-check send-state
3856 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3858 yes | no | yes | yes
3859 Arguments : none
3860
3861 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3862 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3863 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3864 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3865 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3866
3867 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3868 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3869 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3870 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3871 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003872 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3873 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3874 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3875
3876 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3877 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3878 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3879
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003880 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3881 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3882 checked in multiple backends.
3883
3884 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3885 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3886
3887 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3888 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3889 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3890 one fails.
3891
3892 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3893 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3894 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3895
3896 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3897 server's queue.
3898
3899 Example of a header received by the application server :
3900 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3901 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3902
3903 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3904
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01003905http-request { allow | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> | reject |
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003906 tarpit [deny_status <status>] | deny [deny_status <status>] |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003907 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003908 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003909 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003910 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3911 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003912 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3913 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003914 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3915 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3916 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003917 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003918 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01003919 unset-var(<var name>) |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003920 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003921 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01003922 sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003923 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003924 silent-drop |
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01003925 send-spoe-group |
3926 cache-use
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003927 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003928 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003929 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3930
3931 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3932 no | yes | yes | yes
3933
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003934 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3935 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3936 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3937 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3938 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003939
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003940 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3941 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3942 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3943
3944 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003945 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code
3946 specified as an argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status
3947 codes is limited to those that can be overridden by the "errorfile"
3948 directive. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003949
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01003950 - "reject" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes
3951 the connection without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
3952 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an
3953 immediate connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
3954
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003955 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3956 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3957 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003958 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status
3959 code specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003960 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3961 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3962 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3963 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3964 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003965 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003966 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3967 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003968
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003969 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3970 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3971 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3972 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3973 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3974
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003975 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3976 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3977 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003978 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3979 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003980
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003981 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3982 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3983 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003984 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003985 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3986 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3987 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3988 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3989
3990 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3991 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3992 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003993 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3994 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003995
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003996 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3997 <name>.
3998
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003999 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4000 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4001 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4002 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4003 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4004 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4005 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4006 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
4007
4008 Example:
4009
4010 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4011
4012 applied to:
4013
4014 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4015
4016 outputs:
4017
4018 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4019
4020 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
4021
4022 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4023 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4024 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4025 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4026 header.
4027
4028 Example:
4029
4030 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
4031
4032 applied to:
4033
4034 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
4035
4036 outputs:
4037
4038 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
4039
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004040 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
4041 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
4042 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
4043 it.
4044
4045 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
4046 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
4047 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
4048 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
4049 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
4050 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
4051
4052 Example :
4053 # prepend the host name before the path
4054 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
4055
4056 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
4057 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
4058 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
4059 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
4060 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
4061 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
4062 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
4063 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
4064
4065 Example :
4066 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4067 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
4068
4069 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
4070 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
4071 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
4072 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
4073 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
4074 "set-query".
4075
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004076 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4077 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4078 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4079 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4080 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4081 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4082 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4083 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4084
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004085 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4086 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4087 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4088 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4089 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4090 another equipment.
4091
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004092 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4093 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4094 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4095 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4096 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004097 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004098 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4099 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4100
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004101 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4102 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4103 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4104 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4105 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4106 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4107 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4108 admin privileges.
4109
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004110 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4111 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4112 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4113 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4114 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4115 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4116 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4117 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4118
4119 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4120 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4121 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4122 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4123 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4124 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4125
4126 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4127 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4128 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4129 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4130 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4131 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4132
4133 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4134 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4135 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4136 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4137 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4138 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4139 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4140 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4141 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4142
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004143 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004144 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
4145 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4146 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
4147 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
4148 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
4149 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
4150 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
4151 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4152 request header" for more information.
4153
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004154 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
4155 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
4156 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
4157 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004158 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4159 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004160
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004161 - cache-use <name> :
4162 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
4163
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004164 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4165 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
4166 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
4167 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
4168 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
4169 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
4170 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
4171 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
4172 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
4173 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
4174 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
4175 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4176
4177 These actions take one or two arguments :
4178 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
4179 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004180 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004181 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
4182
4183 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
4184 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
4185 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
4186 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
4187
4188 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
4189 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
4190 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
4191 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
4192 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
4193 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
4194 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
4195 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
4196
4197 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
4198 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
4199 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
4200 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
4201 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
4202
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004203 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4204 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4205 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4206 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4207 continues.
4208
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004209 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4210 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4211 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4212 the actions evaluation continues.
4213
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004214 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
4215 Same as "sc-inc-gpc0" action above but for GPC1 counter.
4216
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004217 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
4218 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4219 inline.
4220
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004221 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4222 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004223 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004224 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4225 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004226 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004227 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004228 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004229 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4230 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004231 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004232 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004233 and '_'.
4234
4235 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4236 followed by some converters.
4237
4238 Example:
4239
4240 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
4241
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004242 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4243 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4244
4245 Example:
4246
4247 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
4248
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004249 - set-src <expr> :
4250 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4251 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
4252 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4253 source IP for privacy.
4254
4255 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4256 followed by some converters.
4257
4258 Example:
4259
4260 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4261 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4262
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004263 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4264 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004265
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004266 - set-src-port <expr> :
4267 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4268 expression.
4269
4270 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4271 followed by some converters.
4272
4273 Example:
4274
4275 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4276 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4277
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004278 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
4279 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
4280 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004281
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004282 - set-dst <expr> :
4283 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4284 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination
4285 IP, but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4286 the IP for privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4287 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4288
4289 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4290 followed by some converters.
4291
4292 Example:
4293
4294 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4295 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
4296
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004297 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
4298 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
4299
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004300 - set-dst-port <expr> :
4301 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4302 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4303 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4304
4305 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4306 followed by some converters.
4307
4308 Example:
4309
4310 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4311 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
4312
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004313 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4314 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4315 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4316
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004317 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004318 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004319 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4320 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4321 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4322 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4323 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004324 down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact of using
4325 this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the client and
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004326 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4327 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4328 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4329 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4330 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4331 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4332 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4333
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004334
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004335 - "wait-for-handshake" : this will delay the processing of the request
4336 until the SSL handshake happened. This is mostly useful to delay
4337 processing early data until we're sure they are valid.
4338
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004339 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name> :
4340 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do
4341 so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the
4342 SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing
4343 SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the
4344 SPOE agent name must be used.
4345
4346 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4347
4348 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4349 configuration.
4350
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004351 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
4352
4353 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4354 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004355 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4356 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
4357
4358 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4359 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4360 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4361 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004362
4363 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004364 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4365 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4366 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004367
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004368 http-request allow if nagios
4369 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4370 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4371 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004372
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004373 Example:
4374 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004375 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004376
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004377 Example:
4378 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4379 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02004380 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004381 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4382 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4383 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4384 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4385 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4386 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
4387
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004388 Example:
4389 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4390 acl add path /addacl
4391 acl del path /delacl
4392
4393 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4394
4395 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4396 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
4397
4398 Example:
4399 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4400 acl setmap path /setmap
4401 acl delmap path /delmap
4402
4403 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4404
4405 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4406 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
4407
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02004408 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4409 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004410
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004411http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004412 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004413 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004414 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
4415 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004416 set-status <status> [reason <str>] |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004417 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
4418 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4419 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4420 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01004421 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004422 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004423 unset-var(<var-name>) |
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004424 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004425 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004426 sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004427 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004428 silent-drop |
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004429 send-spoe-group |
4430 cache-store
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004431 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02004432 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004433 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4434
4435 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4436 no | yes | yes | yes
4437
4438 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4439 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4440 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4441 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4442 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4443 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4444
4445 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
4446 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
4447 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
4448 current section.
4449
4450 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
4451 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
4452 rules are evaluated.
4453
4454 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4455 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
4456 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
4457 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
4458 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4459 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
4460 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
4461
4462 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
4463 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4464 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4465 external users.
4466
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004467 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
4468 <name>.
4469
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004470 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4471 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4472 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4473 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4474 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4475 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4476 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4477 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
4478
4479 Example:
4480
4481 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4482
4483 applied to:
4484
4485 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4486
4487 outputs:
4488
4489 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4490
4491 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4492
4493 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4494 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4495 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4496 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4497 header.
4498
4499 Example:
4500
4501 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4502
4503 applied to:
4504
4505 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4506
4507 outputs:
4508
4509 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4510
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004511 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004512 be an integer between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be
4513 provided defined by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code
4514 will be used as a fallback.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004515
4516 Example:
4517
4518 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4519 http-response set-status 431
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004520 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4521 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004522
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004523 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4524 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4525 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4526 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4527 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4528 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4529 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4530 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4531
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004532 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4533 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4534 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4535 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4536 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4537 another equipment.
4538
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004539 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4540 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4541 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4542 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4543 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004544 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004545 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4546 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4547
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004548 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4549 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4550 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4551 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4552 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4553 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4554 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4555 admin privileges.
4556
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004557 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4558 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4559 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4560 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4561 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4562 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4563 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4564 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4565
4566 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4567 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4568 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4569 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4570 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4571 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4572
4573 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4574 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4575 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4576 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4577 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4578 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4579
4580 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4581 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4582 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4583 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4584 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4585 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4586 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4587 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4588 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4589
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004590 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4591 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4592 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4593 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4594 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4595 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4596 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4597 response header" for more information.
4598
4599 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4600 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4601 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4602 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4603 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004604 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4605 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004606
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004607 - cache-store <name> :
4608 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
4609
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004610 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4611 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4612 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4613 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4614 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4615 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4616
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004617 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4618 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4619 inline.
4620
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004621 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4622 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004623 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004624 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4625 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004626 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004627 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004628 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004629 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4630 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004631 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01004632 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
4633 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004634
4635 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4636 followed by some converters.
4637
4638 Example:
4639
4640 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4641
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004642 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4643 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4644
4645 Example:
4646
4647 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4648
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004649 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4650 enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer to
4651 "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4652 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004653 use of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below
4654 Layer 6 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004655 not supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4656
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004657 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4658 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4659 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4660 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4661 continues.
4662
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004663 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4664 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4665 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4666 the actions evaluation continues.
4667
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004668 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
4669 Same as "sc-inc-gpc0" action above but for GPC1 counter.
4670
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004671 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004672 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004673 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4674 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4675 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4676 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4677 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004678 down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact of using
4679 this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the client and
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004680 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4681 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4682 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4683 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4684 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4685 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4686 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4687
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004688 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name> :
4689 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do
4690 so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the
4691 SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing
4692 SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the
4693 SPOE agent name must be used.
4694
4695 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4696
4697 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4698 configuration.
4699
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004700 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4701
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004702 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004703 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004704 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
4705 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004706
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004707 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4708 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4709 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4710 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4711
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004712 Example:
4713 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4714
4715 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4716
4717 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4718 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4719
4720 Example:
4721 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4722
4723 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4724
4725 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4726 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4727
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004728 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4729 ACL usage.
4730
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004731
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004732http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4733 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4734
4735 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4736 yes | no | yes | yes
4737
4738 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4739 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4740 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4741 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4742 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004743 This directive allows to tune this behavior.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004744
4745 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4746
4747 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4748 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4749 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4750 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4751 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4752 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4753 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4754 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4755 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4756 not checking any request past the first one.
4757
4758 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4759 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4760 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4761 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4762 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4763 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4764 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4765
4766 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4767 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4768 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4769 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4770 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4771 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4772 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4773 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4774 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4775 downsides of rare connection failures.
4776
4777 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4778 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4779 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4780 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4781 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4782 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004783 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004784 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4785 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4786 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4787 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4788 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4789
4790 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004791 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
4792 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
4793 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004794
4795 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004796 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004797
4798 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4799 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4800 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004801 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004802
4803 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4804 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4805 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4806
4807 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4808 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4809 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4810
4811 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4812
4813
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004814http-send-name-header [<header>]
4815 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4816
4817 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4818 yes | no | yes | yes
4819
4820 Arguments :
4821
4822 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4823
4824 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004825 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004826 is added with the header string proved.
4827
4828 See also : "server"
4829
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004830id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004831 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4833 no | yes | yes | yes
4834 Arguments : none
4835
4836 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4837 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4838 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004839
4840
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004841ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4842 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4843 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004844 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004845
4846 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4847 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4848 and running).
4849
4850 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4851 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4852 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004853 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004854 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4855
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004856 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4857 "unless" condition is met.
4858
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004859 Example:
4860 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
4861 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
4862 ignore-persist if url_static
4863
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004864 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4865
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004866load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4867 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4868 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4869 yes | no | yes | yes
4870
4871 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4872 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4873 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004874 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004875 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4876 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4877 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4878 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4879
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004880 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004881 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02004882 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004883
4884 Arguments:
4885 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4886 named "server-state-file".
4887
4888 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4889 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4890 name is used as a file name.
4891
4892 none don't load any stat for this backend
4893
4894 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01004895 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
4896 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
4897 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004898 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01004899 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004900
4901 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4902 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4903
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004904 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004905
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004906 global
4907 stats socket /tmp/socket
4908 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004909
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004910 defaults
4911 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004912
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004913 backend bk
4914 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4915 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004916
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004917
4918 Then one can run :
4919
4920 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4921
4922 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4923
4924 1
4925 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4926 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4927 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4928
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004929 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004930
4931 global
4932 stats socket /tmp/socket
4933 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4934
4935 defaults
4936 load-server-state-from-file local
4937
4938 backend bk
4939 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4940 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4941
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004942
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004943 Then one can run :
4944
4945 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4946
4947 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4948
4949 1
4950 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4951 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4952 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4953
4954 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4955 "show servers state"
4956
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004957
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004958log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004959log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004960no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004961 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4963 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004964
4965 Prefix :
4966 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4967 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4968 prefix does not allow arguments.
4969
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004970 Arguments :
4971 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4972 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4973 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4974 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4975 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4976 parameter.
4977
4978 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4979 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4980
4981 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4982 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4983 standard syslog port).
4984
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004985 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4986 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4987 standard syslog port).
4988
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004989 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4990 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4991 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004992 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004993
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004994 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4995 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004996
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004997 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4998 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4999 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5000 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5001 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5002 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5003 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5004 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5005 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5006 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005007 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005008
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005009 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5010
5011 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5012 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5013 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5014
5015 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5016 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5017 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005018 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5019 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5020 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5021 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5022 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005023
5024 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5025
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005026 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5027 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5028 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005029
5030 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5031 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5032 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5033 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5034
5035 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5036 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005037
5038 Example :
5039 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005040 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5041 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005042 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005043
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005044
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005045log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005046 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5047 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5048 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005049
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005050 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5051 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5052 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5053 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5054 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005055
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005056 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5057 "option httplog" directives.
5058
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005059log-format-sd <string>
5060 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5061 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5062 yes | yes | yes | no
5063
5064 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5065 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5066 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5067 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5068 which covers the log format string in depth.
5069
5070 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5071 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5072
5073 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5074 log format to "rfc5424".
5075
5076 Example :
5077 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5078
5079
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005080log-tag <string>
5081 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5082 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5083 yes | yes | yes | yes
5084
5085 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5086 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5087 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5088 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5089 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5090 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5091 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5092 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5093 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005094
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005095max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5096 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5097 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5098 yes | no | yes | yes
5099
5100 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5101 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5102 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5103 servers.
5104
5105 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5106 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5107 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5108 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5109 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005110 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005111 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5112 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5113 picking a different server.
5114
5115 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5116 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5117 even if they have to be queued.
5118
5119 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5120 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5121
5122
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005123maxconn <conns>
5124 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5126 yes | yes | yes | no
5127 Arguments :
5128 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5129 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5130 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5131 closes.
5132
5133 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5134 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5135 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5136 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005137 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5138 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5139 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5140 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005141
5142 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5143 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5144 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5145
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005146 By default, this value is set to 2000.
5147
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005148 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5149
5150
5151mode { tcp|http|health }
5152 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5154 yes | yes | yes | yes
5155 Arguments :
5156 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5157 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5158 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5159 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5160
5161 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5162 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5163 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5164 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5165 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5166
5167 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005168 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5169 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5170 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5171 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5172 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5173 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5174 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005175
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005176 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5177 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5178 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005179
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005180 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005181 defaults http_instances
5182 mode http
5183
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005184 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005185
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005186
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005187monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005188 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005189 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5190 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005191 Arguments :
5192 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5193 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005194 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005195 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5196 backend and its backup.
5197
5198 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5199 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5200 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5201 servers in a list of backends.
5202
5203 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5204 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5205 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5206 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5207 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5208 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5209 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005210 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5211 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005212
5213 Example:
5214 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005215 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005216 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5217 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5218 monitor-uri /site_alive
5219 monitor fail if site_dead
5220
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005221 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005222
5223
5224monitor-net <source>
5225 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5227 yes | yes | yes | no
5228 Arguments :
5229 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5230 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5231 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5232 followed by a mask.
5233
5234 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5235 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005236 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005237 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5238
5239 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5240 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5241 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5242 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005243 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5244 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5245 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005246
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005247 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5248 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5249 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5250 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5251 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5252 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005253
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005254 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5255 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005256
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005257 Example :
5258 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5259 frontend www
5260 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5261
5262 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5263
5264
5265monitor-uri <uri>
5266 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5268 yes | yes | yes | no
5269 Arguments :
5270 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5271 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5272
5273 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5274 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5275 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5276 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5277 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5278 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5279 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5280 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5281
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005282 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5283 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5284 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5285 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5286 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5287 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5288 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5289 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005290
5291 Example :
5292 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5293 frontend www
5294 mode http
5295 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5296
5297 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5298
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005299
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005300option abortonclose
5301no option abortonclose
5302 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5303 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5304 yes | no | yes | yes
5305 Arguments : none
5306
5307 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5308 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5309 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5310 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005311 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005312 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5313 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5314 encountered while delivering the response.
5315
5316 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5317 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5318 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5319 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5320 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5321 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005322 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005323 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005324 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005325 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5326 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5327 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5328
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005329 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5330 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005331 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5332 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5333 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5334 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5335 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5336 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005337 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005338
5339 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5340 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5341
5342 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5343
5344
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005345option accept-invalid-http-request
5346no option accept-invalid-http-request
5347 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5348 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5349 yes | yes | yes | no
5350 Arguments : none
5351
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005352 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005353 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005354 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005355 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5356 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5357 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5358 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5359 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005360 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5361 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5362 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5363 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005364 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005365 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005366 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5367 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5368 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005369
5370 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5371 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5372 been confirmed.
5373
5374 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5375 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005376 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5377 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005378 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5379
5380 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5381 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5382
5383 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5384 stats socket.
5385
5386
5387option accept-invalid-http-response
5388no option accept-invalid-http-response
5389 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5391 yes | no | yes | yes
5392 Arguments : none
5393
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005394 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005395 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005396 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005397 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5398 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5399 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5400 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5401 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005402 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5403 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5404 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005405
5406 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5407 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5408 been confirmed.
5409
5410 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5411 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5412 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5413 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5414
5415 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5416 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5417
5418 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5419 stats socket.
5420
5421
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005422option allbackups
5423no option allbackups
5424 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5426 yes | no | yes | yes
5427 Arguments : none
5428
5429 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5430 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5431 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5432 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5433 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5434 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5435 order between the backup servers anymore.
5436
5437 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5438 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5439
5440 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5441 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5442
5443
5444option checkcache
5445no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005446 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005447 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5448 yes | no | yes | yes
5449 Arguments : none
5450
5451 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5452 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005453 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005454 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5455 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005456 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005457
5458 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005459 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005460 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005461 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5462 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005463 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005464 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01005465 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
5466 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005467 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01005468 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
5469 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005470 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005471 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5472 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5473 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5474 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5475 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5476 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5477 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5478 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5479 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5480
5481 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005482 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005483 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005484 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005485 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5486
5487 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5488 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005489 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005490 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005491
5492 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5493 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5494
5495
5496option clitcpka
5497no option clitcpka
5498 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5499 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5500 yes | yes | yes | no
5501 Arguments : none
5502
5503 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5504 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005505 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005506 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5507
5508 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5509 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5510 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5511 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5512
5513 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5514 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5515 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5516 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5517 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5518
5519 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5520
5521 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5522 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5523 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5524
5525 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5526 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5527
5528 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5529
5530
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005531option contstats
5532 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5534 yes | yes | yes | no
5535 Arguments : none
5536
5537 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5538 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5539 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5540 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005541 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5542 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5543 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5544 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5545 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005546
5547
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005548option dontlog-normal
5549no option dontlog-normal
5550 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5552 yes | yes | yes | no
5553 Arguments : none
5554
5555 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5556 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5557 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5558 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5559 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5560 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5561 logged.
5562
5563 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5564 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5565 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5566
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005567 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005568 logging.
5569
5570
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005571option dontlognull
5572no option dontlognull
5573 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5575 yes | yes | yes | no
5576 Arguments : none
5577
5578 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5579 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5580 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5581 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5582 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5583 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005584 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5585 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5586 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005587
5588 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005589 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005590 would not be logged.
5591
5592 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5593 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5594
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005595 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5596 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005597
5598
5599option forceclose
5600no option forceclose
5601 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
5602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01005603 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005604 Arguments : none
5605
5606 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
5607 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
5608 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
5609 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
5610 global session times in the logs.
5611
5612 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01005613 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005614 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005615
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005616 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
5617 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
5618 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
5619
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005620 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5621 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005622
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005623 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5624 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5625
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005626 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005627
5628
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005629option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005630 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5632 yes | yes | yes | yes
5633 Arguments :
5634 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5635 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005636 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005637 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005638
5639 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5640 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5641 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5642 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5643 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5644 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5645 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005646 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5647 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5648 possible that the client has already brought one.
5649
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005650 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005651 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005652 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005653 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005654 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005655 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005656
5657 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5658 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5659 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5660 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5661 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5662 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5663 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5664
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005665 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5666 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5667 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5668 are under the control of the end-user.
5669
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005670 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005671 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5672 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005673 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5674 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5675 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005676
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005677 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005678 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5679 frontend www
5680 mode http
5681 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5682
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005683 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5684 backend www
5685 mode http
5686 option forwardfor header X-Client
5687
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005688 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005689 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005690
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005691
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005692option http-buffer-request
5693no option http-buffer-request
5694 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5696 yes | yes | yes | yes
5697 Arguments : none
5698
5699 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5700 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5701 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5702 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5703 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5704 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5705 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5706 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005707 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005708 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5709 default.
5710
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005711 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005712
5713
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005714option http-ignore-probes
5715no option http-ignore-probes
5716 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5718 yes | yes | yes | no
5719 Arguments : none
5720
5721 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5722 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5723 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5724 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5725 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5726 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5727 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5728 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5729 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005730 was received over a connection before it was closed;
5731 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005732 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5733
5734 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5735 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5736 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5737 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5738 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5739 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5740 are often the only way to detect them.
5741
5742 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5743 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5744
5745 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5746
5747
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005748option http-keep-alive
5749no option http-keep-alive
5750 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5752 yes | yes | yes | yes
5753 Arguments : none
5754
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005755 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5756 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5757 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5758 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5759 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5760 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5761 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5762
5763 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5764 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005765 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5766 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5767 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5768 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5769 situations where this option may be useful :
5770
5771 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005772 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005773
5774 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5775 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5776
5777 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5778 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5779 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5780 request.
5781
5782 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5783 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005784 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5785 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5786 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005787
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005788 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5789 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5790 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5791 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5792 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5793 not set.
5794
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005795 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5796 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005797 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005798 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005799
5800 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005801 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5802 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005803
5804
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005805option http-no-delay
5806no option http-no-delay
5807 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5809 yes | yes | yes | yes
5810 Arguments : none
5811
5812 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5813 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5814 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5815 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5816 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5817 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5818 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5819 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5820 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5821 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5822 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5823 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5824 affected.
5825
5826 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5827 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5828 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5829 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5830 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5831 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5832 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5833 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5834 latency environments.
5835
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005836 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5837
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005838
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005839option http-pretend-keepalive
5840no option http-pretend-keepalive
5841 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5843 yes | yes | yes | yes
5844 Arguments : none
5845
5846 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5847 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5848 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5849 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5850 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5851 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5852 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5853 consider the response complete.
5854
5855 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5856 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5857 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5858 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5859 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5860 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5861
5862 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5863 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5864 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5865 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5866 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5867 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5868 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5869
5870 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5871 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005872 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005873 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5874 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005875
5876 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5877 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5878
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005879 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5880 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005881
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005882
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005883option http-server-close
5884no option http-server-close
5885 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5886 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5887 yes | yes | yes | yes
5888 Arguments : none
5889
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005890 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5891 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5892 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5893 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5894 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5895 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5896 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005897 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005898 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5899 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5900 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00005901 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005902 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5903 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5904 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5905 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005906
5907 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5908 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5909 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5910 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005911 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5912 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005913
5914 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5915 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005916 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5917 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005918 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5919 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005920
5921 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5922 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5923
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005924 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005925 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5926 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005927
5928
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005929option http-tunnel
5930no option http-tunnel
5931 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5933 yes | yes | yes | yes
5934 Arguments : none
5935
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005936 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5937 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5938 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5939 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5940 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5941 "option http-tunnel".
5942
5943 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005944 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005945 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5946 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5947 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5948 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5949 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5950 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5951 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005952
5953 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5954 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5955
5956 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5957 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5958 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5959
5960
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005961option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005962no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005963 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5965 yes | yes | yes | no
5966 Arguments : none
5967
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00005968 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005969 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5970 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5971 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5972 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5973 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5974 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5975
5976 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5977 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005978 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
5979 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
5980 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005981
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005982 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5983 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5984 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5985 front of an existing proxy.
5986
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005987 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5988
5989 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5990 http-server-close".
5991
5992
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005993option httpchk
5994option httpchk <uri>
5995option httpchk <method> <uri>
5996option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5997 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5998 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5999 yes | no | yes | yes
6000 Arguments :
6001 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6002 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6003 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6004 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6005 ones.
6006
6007 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6008 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6009 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6010
6011 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6012 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6013 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6014 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6015 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6016
6017 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6018 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6019 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6020 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6021 the lack of any response.
6022
6023 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6024
6025 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6026 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6027 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6028
6029 Examples :
6030 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6031 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6032 backend https_relay
6033 mode tcp
6034 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6035 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6036
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006037 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6038 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6039 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006040
6041
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006042option httpclose
6043no option httpclose
6044 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
6045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6046 yes | yes | yes | yes
6047 Arguments : none
6048
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006049 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6050 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6051 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6052 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006053 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006054 "option http-tunnel".
6055
6056 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
6057 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
6058 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
6059 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
6060 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
6061 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
6062 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
6063 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006064
6065 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006066 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01006067 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
6068 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
6069 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
6070 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
6071 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006072
6073 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6074 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006075 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
6076 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006077 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
6078 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006079
6080 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6081 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6082
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02006083 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
6084 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006085
6086
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006087option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006088 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006090 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006091 Arguments :
6092 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6093 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6094 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006095 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006096 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006097
6098 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6099 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6100 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6101 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6102 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6103 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6104 ports.
6105
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006106 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6107 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006108
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006109 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6110
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006111 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006112
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006113
6114option http_proxy
6115no option http_proxy
6116 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6118 yes | yes | yes | yes
6119 Arguments : none
6120
6121 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6122 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6123 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6124 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6125 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6126
6127 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6128 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006129 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6130 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006131
6132 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6133 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6134
6135 Example :
6136 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6137 backend direct_forward
6138 option httpclose
6139 option http_proxy
6140
6141 See also : "option httpclose"
6142
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006143
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006144option independent-streams
6145no option independent-streams
6146 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6148 yes | yes | yes | yes
6149 Arguments : none
6150
6151 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6152 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6153 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6154 receive data or not.
6155
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006156 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006157 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6158 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6159 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6160 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6161 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6162 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6163 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6164 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6165 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6166 socket buffers.
6167
6168 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6169 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6170 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6171 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6172 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6173
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006174 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006175 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6176 deprecated.
6177
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006178 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006179
6180
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006181option ldap-check
6182 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6184 yes | no | yes | yes
6185 Arguments : none
6186
6187 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6188 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6189 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6190 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6191
6192 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6193 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6194
6195 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6196 configure it.
6197
6198 Example :
6199 option ldap-check
6200
6201 See also : "option httpchk"
6202
6203
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006204option external-check
6205 Use external processes for server health checks
6206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6207 yes | no | yes | yes
6208
6209 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6210 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6211 command".
6212
6213 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6214
6215 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6216
6217
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006218option log-health-checks
6219no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006220 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006221 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6222 yes | no | yes | yes
6223 Arguments : none
6224
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006225 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6226 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6227 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006228
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006229 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6230 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6231 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6232 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6233 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6234
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006235 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006236 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006237
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006238 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6239 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6240 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006241
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006242
6243option log-separate-errors
6244no option log-separate-errors
6245 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6247 yes | yes | yes | no
6248 Arguments : none
6249
6250 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6251 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6252 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6253 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6254 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6255 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6256 provides very important information.
6257
6258 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6259 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6260 error logs.
6261
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006262 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006263 logging.
6264
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006265
6266option logasap
6267no option logasap
6268 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6269 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6270 yes | yes | yes | no
6271 Arguments : none
6272
6273 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6274 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6275 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6276 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6277 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6278 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6279 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006280 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006281 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6282 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6283
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006284 Examples :
6285 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6286 mode http
6287 option httplog
6288 option logasap
6289 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6290
6291 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6292 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6293 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6294 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6295
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006296 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006297 logging.
6298
6299
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006300option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006301 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006302 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6303 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006304 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006305 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6306 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006307 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006308
6309 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6310 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006311 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006312 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6313 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6314 in the MySQL table, like this :
6315
6316 USE mysql;
6317 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6318 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6319
6320 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006321 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006322 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6323 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6324 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6325 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6326 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6327 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6328 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6329
6330 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6331 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006332
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006333 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006334
6335 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6336 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6337 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6338 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006339 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6340 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006341
6342 See also: "option httpchk"
6343
6344
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006345option nolinger
6346no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006347 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006348 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6349 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006350 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006351
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006352 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006353 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6354 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6355 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6356 connections.
6357
6358 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6359 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6360 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6361 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6362 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6363 this too.
6364
6365 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6366 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6367 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6368
6369 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6370 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6371 for servers.
6372
6373 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6374 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6375
6376
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006377option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6378 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6379 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6380 yes | yes | yes | yes
6381 Arguments :
6382 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6383 matching <network>
6384 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6385 header name.
6386
6387 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6388 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6389 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6390 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6391 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6392 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6393 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6394 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6395 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6396 possible that the client has already brought one.
6397
6398 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6399 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6400 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6401 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6402 header and requires different one.
6403
6404 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6405 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6406 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6407 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6408 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6409 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6410 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6411
6412 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6413 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6414 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6415 both are defined.
6416
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006417 Examples :
6418 # Original Destination address
6419 frontend www
6420 mode http
6421 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6422
6423 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6424 backend www
6425 mode http
6426 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6427
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006428 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6429 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006430
6431
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006432option persist
6433no option persist
6434 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6435 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6436 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006437 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006438
6439 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6440 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6441 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6442 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6443 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6444 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6445 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6446 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6447 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6448 redirected to another valid server.
6449
6450 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6451 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6452
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006453 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006454
6455
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006456option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6457 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6459 yes | no | yes | yes
6460 Arguments :
6461 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6462 PostgreSQL server.
6463
6464 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6465 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6466 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6467 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6468
6469 See also: "option httpchk"
6470
6471
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006472option prefer-last-server
6473no option prefer-last-server
6474 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6475 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6476 yes | no | yes | yes
6477 Arguments : none
6478
6479 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6480 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6481 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6482 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6483 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6484 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6485 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6486 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6487 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006488 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6489 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
6490 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
6491 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
6492 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6493 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6494 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006495
6496 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6497 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6498
6499 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6500
6501
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006502option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006503option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006504no option redispatch
6505 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6506 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6507 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006508 Arguments :
6509 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6510 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6511 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006512 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006513 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006514 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006515 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6516 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6517 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6518
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006519
6520 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6521 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6522 be able to access the service anymore.
6523
6524 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6525 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6526
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006527 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006528 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6529 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006530
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006531 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6532 "redisp" keywords.
6533
6534 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6535 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6536
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006537 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006538
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006539
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006540option redis-check
6541 Use redis health checks for server testing
6542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6543 yes | no | yes | yes
6544 Arguments : none
6545
6546 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6547 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6548 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6549 find the "+PONG" response message.
6550
6551 Example :
6552 option redis-check
6553
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006554 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006555
6556
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006557option smtpchk
6558option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6559 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6561 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006562 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006563 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
6564 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
6565 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6566
6567 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6568 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6569 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6570
6571 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6572 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6573 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6574 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6575 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6576 dead server.
6577
6578 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6579 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006580 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006581 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6582
6583 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6584 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6585 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6586 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006587 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006588
6589 Example :
6590 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6591
6592 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6593
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006594
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006595option socket-stats
6596no option socket-stats
6597
6598 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6600 yes | yes | yes | no
6601
6602 Arguments : none
6603
6604
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006605option splice-auto
6606no option splice-auto
6607 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6609 yes | yes | yes | yes
6610 Arguments : none
6611
6612 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6613 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006614 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006615 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006616 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006617 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6618 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6619 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6620 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6621
6622 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6623 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6624 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6625 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6626 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6627 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6628 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6629 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6630 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6631 keyword.
6632
6633 Example :
6634 option splice-auto
6635
6636 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6637 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6638
6639 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6640 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6641
6642
6643option splice-request
6644no option splice-request
6645 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6647 yes | yes | yes | yes
6648 Arguments : none
6649
6650 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006651 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006652 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6653 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6654 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6655 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6656
6657 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6658
6659 Example :
6660 option splice-request
6661
6662 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6663 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6664
6665 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6666 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6667
6668
6669option splice-response
6670no option splice-response
6671 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6673 yes | yes | yes | yes
6674 Arguments : none
6675
6676 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006677 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006678 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6679 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6680 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6681 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6682
6683 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6684
6685 Example :
6686 option splice-response
6687
6688 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6689 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6690
6691 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6692 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6693
6694
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01006695option spop-check
6696 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
6697 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6698 no | no | no | yes
6699 Arguments : none
6700
6701 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
6702 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6703 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
6704 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
6705
6706 Example :
6707 option spop-check
6708
6709 See also : "option httpchk"
6710
6711
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006712option srvtcpka
6713no option srvtcpka
6714 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6716 yes | no | yes | yes
6717 Arguments : none
6718
6719 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6720 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006721 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006722 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6723
6724 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6725 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6726 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6727 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6728
6729 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6730 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6731 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6732 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6733 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6734
6735 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6736
6737 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6738 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6739 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6740
6741 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6742 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6743
6744 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6745
6746
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006747option ssl-hello-chk
6748 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6750 yes | no | yes | yes
6751 Arguments : none
6752
6753 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6754 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6755 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6756 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6757 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6758 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6759 hello message.
6760
6761 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6762 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6763 messages, which is appreciable.
6764
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006765 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6766 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6767 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006768
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006769 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6770
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006771
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006772option tcp-check
6773 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6774 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6775 yes | no | yes | yes
6776
6777 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6778 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6779
6780 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6781 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6782 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6783
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006784 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006785 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6786 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6787 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6788 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6789 only.
6790
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006791 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006792 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6793 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6794 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6795 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6796
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006797 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006798 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
6799 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006800 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006801 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6802 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6803 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6804 the respective protocols.
6805 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006806 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006807
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006808 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6809 script.
6810
6811 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6812 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6813 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6814 The "comment" is of course optional.
6815
6816
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006817 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006818 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006819 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006820 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006821
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006822 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006823 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006824 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006825
6826 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6827 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006828 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006829 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006830 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006831 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006832 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006833 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006834 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6835 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006836 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006837 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6838 tcp-check expect string +OK
6839
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006840 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006841 (send many headers before analyzing)
6842 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006843 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006844 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6845 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6846 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6847 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006848 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006849
6850
6851 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6852
6853
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006854option tcp-smart-accept
6855no option tcp-smart-accept
6856 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6858 yes | yes | yes | no
6859 Arguments : none
6860
6861 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6862 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6863 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6864 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6865 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6866 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6867
6868 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6869 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6870 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6871 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6872
6873 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6874 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6875 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006876 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006877
6878 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6879 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6880 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6881
6882 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6883 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6884 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6885
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006886 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6887
6888
6889option tcp-smart-connect
6890no option tcp-smart-connect
6891 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6892 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6893 yes | no | yes | yes
6894 Arguments : none
6895
6896 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6897 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6898 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6899 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6900 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6901
6902 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6903 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6904 complex.
6905
6906 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6907 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6908 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6909
6910 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6911 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6912
6913 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6914
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006915
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006916option tcpka
6917 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6918 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6919 yes | yes | yes | yes
6920 Arguments : none
6921
6922 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6923 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006924 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006925 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6926
6927 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6928 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6929 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6930 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6931
6932 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6933 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6934 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6935 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6936 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6937
6938 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6939
6940 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6941 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6942 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6943 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6944 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6945 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6946 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6947 backends.
6948
6949 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6950
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006951
6952option tcplog
6953 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6954 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006955 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006956 Arguments : none
6957
6958 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6959 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6960 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6961 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6962 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6963 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6964 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6965 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6966
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006967 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6968
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006969 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006970
6971
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006972option transparent
6973no option transparent
6974 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006976 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006977 Arguments : none
6978
6979 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6980 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6981 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6982 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6983 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6984 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6985 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6986 appropriate server.
6987
6988 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6989 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6990
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006991 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006992 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006993
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006994
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006995external-check command <command>
6996 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6997 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6998 yes | no | yes | yes
6999
7000 Arguments :
7001 <command> is the external command to run
7002
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007003 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7004
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007005 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007006
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007007 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7008 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7009 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7010 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7011 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7012 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007013
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007014 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7015
7016 Environment variables :
7017 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7018 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7019
7020 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7021
7022 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7023
7024 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7025 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7026 for a UNIX socket).
7027
7028 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7029
7030 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7031
7032 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7033
7034 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7035
7036 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7037
7038 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7039 socket).
7040
7041 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7042 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7043
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007044 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7045 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7046 failed.
7047
7048 Example :
7049 external-check command /bin/true
7050
7051 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7052
7053
7054external-check path <path>
7055 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7057 yes | no | yes | yes
7058
7059 Arguments :
7060 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7061
7062 The default path is "".
7063
7064 Example :
7065 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7066
7067 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7068 "external-check command"
7069
7070
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007071persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007072persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007073 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7075 yes | no | yes | yes
7076 Arguments :
7077 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007078 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7079 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007080
7081 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7082 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007083 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007084 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7085 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7086 forwarded to this server.
7087
7088 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7089 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7090 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007091 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007092 a single "listen" section.
7093
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007094 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7095 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7096 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7097
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007098 Example :
7099 listen tse-farm
7100 bind :3389
7101 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7102 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7103 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7104 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7105 persist rdp-cookie
7106 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007107 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007108 balance rdp-cookie
7109 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7110 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7111
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007112 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7113 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007114
7115
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007116rate-limit sessions <rate>
7117 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7119 yes | yes | yes | no
7120 Arguments :
7121 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7122 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7123
7124 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7125 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7126 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7127 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7128 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7129 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7130
7131 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7132 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7133 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7134 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7135
7136 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7137 listen smtp
7138 mode tcp
7139 bind :25
7140 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007141 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007142
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007143 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7144 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7145 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007146
7147 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7148
7149
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007150redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7151redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7152redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007153 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7155 no | yes | yes | yes
7156
7157 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007158 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007159
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007160 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007161 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007162 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7163 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7164 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007165
7166 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7167 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7168 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7169 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7170 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007171 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7172 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7173 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7174 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007175
7176 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7177 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7178 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7179 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7180 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7181 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007182 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007183 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007184 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7185 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7186 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007187
7188 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007189 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7190 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7191 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007192 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007193 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7194 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7195 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7196 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007197
7198 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007199 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007200
7201 - "drop-query"
7202 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7203 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7204 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7205 with a location-type redirect.
7206
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007207 - "append-slash"
7208 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7209 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7210 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7211 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7212
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007213 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7214 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7215 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7216 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7217 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7218 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7219 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7220
7221 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7222 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7223 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7224 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7225 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7226 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7227 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007228
7229 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7230 acl clear dst_port 80
7231 acl secure dst_port 8080
7232 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007233 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007234 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007235 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7236
7237 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007238 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7239 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7240 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007241 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007242
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007243 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7244 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7245 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7246
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007247 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007248 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007249
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007250 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007251 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7252 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7253 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007254
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007255 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007256
7257
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007258redisp (deprecated)
7259redispatch (deprecated)
7260 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7261 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7262 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007263 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007264
7265 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7266 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7267 be able to access the service anymore.
7268
7269 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7270 redistribute them to a working server.
7271
7272 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7273 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7274 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007275
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007276 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7277 "option redispatch" instead.
7278
7279 See also : "option redispatch"
7280
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007281
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007282reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007283 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7284 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7285 no | yes | yes | yes
7286 Arguments :
7287 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7288 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007289 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007290
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007291 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7292 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7293
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007294 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7295 the last header of an HTTP request.
7296
7297 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7298 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7299 responses.
7300
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007301 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7302 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7303 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7304
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007305 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7306 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007307
7308
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007309reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7310reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007311 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7313 no | yes | yes | yes
7314 Arguments :
7315 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7316 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7317 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7318 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7319 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7320 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7321 ignores case.
7322
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007323 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7324 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7325
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007326 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7327 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7328 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7329 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007330 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007331
7332 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7333 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7334
7335 Example :
7336 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7337 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7338 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7339
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007340 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7341 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007342
7343
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007344reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7345reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007346 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7347 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7348 no | yes | yes | yes
7349 Arguments :
7350 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7351 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7352 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7353 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7354 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7355 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7356
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007357 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7358 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7359
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007360 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7361 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7362 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7363 next servers.
7364
7365 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7366 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7367 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7368
7369 Example :
7370 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7371 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7372 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7373
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007374 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7375 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007376
7377
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007378reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7379reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007380 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7382 no | yes | yes | yes
7383 Arguments :
7384 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7385 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7386 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7387 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7388 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7389 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7390 case.
7391
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007392 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7393 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7394
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007395 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7396 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7397 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7398 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007399 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007400
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007401 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007402 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007403 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007404
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007405 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7406 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7407
7408 Example :
7409 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7410 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7411 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7412
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007413 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7414 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007415
7416
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007417reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7418reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007419 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7420 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7421 no | yes | yes | yes
7422 Arguments :
7423 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7424 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7425 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7426 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7427 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7428 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7429 case.
7430
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007431 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7432 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7433
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007434 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7435 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7436 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7437 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7438
7439 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7440 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7441
7442 Example :
7443 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7444 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7445 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7446 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7447
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007448 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7449 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007450
7451
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007452reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7453reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007454 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7456 no | yes | yes | yes
7457 Arguments :
7458 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7459 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7460 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7461 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7462 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7463 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7464
7465 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7466 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7467 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7468 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007469 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007470
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007471 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7472 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7473
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007474 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7475 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7476 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7477
7478 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7479 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7480 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7481 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7482 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7483
7484 Example :
7485 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007486 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007487 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7488 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7489
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007490 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7491 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007492
7493
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007494reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7495reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007496 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7498 no | yes | yes | yes
7499 Arguments :
7500 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7501 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7502 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7503 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7504 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7505 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7506 ignores case.
7507
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007508 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7509 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7510
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007511 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7512 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007513 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7514 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7515 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007516 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7517 not set.
7518
7519 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7520 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7521 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7522 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7523 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7524
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007525 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007526 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007527 # block all others.
7528 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7529 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7530
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007531 # block bad guys
7532 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7533 reqitarpit . if badguys
7534
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007535 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7536 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007537
7538
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007539retries <value>
7540 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7541 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7542 yes | no | yes | yes
7543 Arguments :
7544 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7545 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7546 default value is 3.
7547
7548 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7549 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7550 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7551
7552 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007553 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7554 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007555
7556 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7557 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7558
7559 See also : "option redispatch"
7560
7561
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007562rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007563 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7565 no | yes | yes | yes
7566 Arguments :
7567 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7568 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007569 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007570
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007571 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7572 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7573
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007574 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7575 the last header of an HTTP response.
7576
7577 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7578 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7579 responses.
7580
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007581 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7582 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007583
7584
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007585rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7586rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007587 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7589 no | yes | yes | yes
7590 Arguments :
7591 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7592 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7593 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7594 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7595 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7596 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7597 ignores case.
7598
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007599 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7600 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7601
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007602 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7603 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007604 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007605 client.
7606
7607 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7608 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7609 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7610
7611 Example :
7612 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007613 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007614
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007615 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7616 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007617
7618
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007619rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7620rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007621 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7623 no | yes | yes | yes
7624 Arguments :
7625 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7626 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7627 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7628 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7629 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7630 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7631 ignores case.
7632
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007633 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7634 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7635
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007636 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7637 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7638 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7639 case-sensitive.
7640
7641 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007642 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7643 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7644 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007645
7646 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7647 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7648
7649 Example :
7650 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7651 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7652
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007653 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7654 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007655
7656
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007657rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7658rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007659 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7661 no | yes | yes | yes
7662 Arguments :
7663 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7664 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7665 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7666 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7667 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7668 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7669 ignores case.
7670
7671 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7672 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7673 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7674 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007675 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007676
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007677 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7678 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7679
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007680 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7681 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7682 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7683
7684 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7685 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7686 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7687 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7688 are not case-sensitive.
7689
7690 Example :
7691 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7692 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7693
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007694 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7695 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007696
7697
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007698server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007699 Declare a server in a backend
7700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7701 no | no | yes | yes
7702 Arguments :
7703 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007704 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007705 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007706
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007707 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7708 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7709 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7710 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007711 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7712 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7713 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7714 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7715 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007716 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7717 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7718 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7719 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7720 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7721 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7722 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007723 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007724 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7725 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007726 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7727 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007728
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007729 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007730 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7731 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7732 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7733 adding this value to the client's port.
7734
7735 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7736 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007737 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007738
7739 Examples :
7740 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7741 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007742 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007743 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7744 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7745 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007746
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007747 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7748 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7749 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7750 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7751 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7752
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007753 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7754 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007755
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007756server-state-file-name [<file>]
7757 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7758 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7759 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7760 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7761 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7762 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7763
7764 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7765 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7766
7767 global
7768 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7769
7770 backend bk
7771 load-server-state-from-file
7772
7773 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7774 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007775
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02007776server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
7777 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
7778 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
7779 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7780 no | no | yes | yes
7781
7782 Arguments:
7783 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
7784
7785 <num | range>
7786 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
7787 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
7788 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
7789 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
7790
7791 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
7792
7793 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
7794
7795 <params*>
7796 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
7797 keyword.
7798
7799 Examples:
7800 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
7801 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
7802 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
7803
7804 # or
7805 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
7806
7807 # would be equivalent to:
7808 server srv1 google.com:80 check
7809 server srv2 google.com:80 check
7810 server srv3 google.com:80 check
7811
7812
7813
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007814source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007815source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007816source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007817 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7818 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7819 yes | no | yes | yes
7820 Arguments :
7821 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7822 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007823
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007824 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007825 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7826 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7827 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7828 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7829 supported prefixes are :
7830 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7831 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7832 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007833 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007834 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7835 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007836
7837 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7838 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007839 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7840 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7841 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007842
7843 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7844 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7845 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7846 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7847 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7848 <addr>.
7849
7850 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7851 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7852 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7853 port.
7854
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007855 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7856 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7857 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7858 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007859 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007860 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7861 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7862 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7863 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7864 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7865 HTTP header.
7866
7867 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7868 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007869 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007870 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7871 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7872 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7873 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7874 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7875 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7876 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7877
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007878 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7879 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7880 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7881 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7882 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7883 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7884
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007885 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7886 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7887 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7888 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7889
7890 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7891 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7892 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7893 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7894 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7895 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7896
7897 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7898 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7899 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7900 there are two methods :
7901
7902 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7903 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7904 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7905 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7906 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7907 of the client ranges may be used.
7908
7909 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7910 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7911 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7912 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7913 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7914 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7915 same session.
7916
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007917 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7918 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7919 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007920 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007921
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007922 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7923
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007924 Examples :
7925 backend private
7926 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7927 source 192.168.1.200
7928
7929 backend transparent_ssl1
7930 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7931 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7932
7933 backend transparent_ssl2
7934 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7935 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7936 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7937
7938 backend transparent_ssl3
7939 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7940 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7941 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7942
7943 backend transparent_smtp
7944 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7945 # with Tproxy version 4.
7946 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7947
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007948 backend transparent_http
7949 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7950 # proxy.
7951 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7952
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007953 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007954 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7955
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007956
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007957srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7958 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7960 yes | no | yes | yes
7961 Arguments :
7962 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7963 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7964 as explained at the top of this document.
7965
7966 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7967 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7968 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7969 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7970 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7971 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7972 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7973
7974 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7975 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7976 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7977 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7978 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007979 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007980 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007981 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007982
7983 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7984 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7985 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7986 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7987 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7988 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7989
7990 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7991 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7992
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007993 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7994 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007995
7996
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007997stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7998 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008000 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008001
8002 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8003 matched.
8004
8005 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8006 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8007
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008008 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8009 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008010 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008011
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008012 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8013 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8014 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8015 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008016
8017 Example :
8018 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8019 backend stats_localhost
8020 stats enable
8021 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8022
8023 Example :
8024 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8025 backend stats_auth
8026 stats enable
8027 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8028 stats admin if TRUE
8029
8030 Example :
8031 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8032 userlist stats-auth
8033 group admin users admin
8034 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8035 group readonly users haproxy
8036 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8037
8038 backend stats_auth
8039 stats enable
8040 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8041 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8042 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8043 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8044
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008045 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8046 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8047 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008048
8049
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008050stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8051 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008053 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008054 Arguments :
8055 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8056
8057 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8058
8059 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8060 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8061 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8062 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8063 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8064 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8065
8066 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8067 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8068 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008069 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008070
8071 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8072 report using "stats scope".
8073
8074 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8075 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8076 unobvious parameters.
8077
8078 Example :
8079 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8080 backend public_www
8081 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8082 stats enable
8083 stats hide-version
8084 stats scope .
8085 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008086 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008087 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8088 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8089
8090 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8091 backend private_monitoring
8092 stats enable
8093 stats uri /admin?stats
8094 stats refresh 5s
8095
8096 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8097
8098
8099stats enable
8100 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008102 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008103 Arguments : none
8104
8105 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8106 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8107 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8108 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8109 - stats auth : no authentication
8110 - stats scope : no restriction
8111
8112 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8113 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8114 unobvious parameters.
8115
8116 Example :
8117 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8118 backend public_www
8119 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8120 stats enable
8121 stats hide-version
8122 stats scope .
8123 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008124 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008125 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8126 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8127
8128 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8129 backend private_monitoring
8130 stats enable
8131 stats uri /admin?stats
8132 stats refresh 5s
8133
8134 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8135
8136
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008137stats hide-version
8138 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008140 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008141 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008142
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008143 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8144 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8145 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8146 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8147 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8148 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008149
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008150 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8151 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8152 unobvious parameters.
8153
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008154 Example :
8155 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8156 backend public_www
8157 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008158 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008159 stats hide-version
8160 stats scope .
8161 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008162 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008163 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8164 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008165
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008166 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8167 backend private_monitoring
8168 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008169 stats uri /admin?stats
8170 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008171
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008172 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008173
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008174
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008175stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8176 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8177 Access control for statistics
8178
8179 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8180 no | no | yes | yes
8181
8182 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8183 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8184 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8185 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8186 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8187 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8188
8189 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8190 instance.
8191
8192 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8193 about ACL usage.
8194
8195
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008196stats realm <realm>
8197 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8198 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008199 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008200 Arguments :
8201 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8202 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8203 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8204
8205 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8206 using a backslash ('\').
8207
8208 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8209 only related to authentication.
8210
8211 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8212 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8213 unobvious parameters.
8214
8215 Example :
8216 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8217 backend public_www
8218 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8219 stats enable
8220 stats hide-version
8221 stats scope .
8222 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008223 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008224 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8225 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8226
8227 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8228 backend private_monitoring
8229 stats enable
8230 stats uri /admin?stats
8231 stats refresh 5s
8232
8233 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8234
8235
8236stats refresh <delay>
8237 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008239 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008240 Arguments :
8241 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8242 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8243 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8244 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8245 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8246 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8247
8248 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8249 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8250 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8251 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8252
8253 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8254 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8255 unobvious parameters.
8256
8257 Example :
8258 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8259 backend public_www
8260 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8261 stats enable
8262 stats hide-version
8263 stats scope .
8264 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008265 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008266 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8267 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8268
8269 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8270 backend private_monitoring
8271 stats enable
8272 stats uri /admin?stats
8273 stats refresh 5s
8274
8275 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8276
8277
8278stats scope { <name> | "." }
8279 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8280 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008281 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008282 Arguments :
8283 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8284 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8285 section in which the statement appears.
8286
8287 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8288 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8289 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8290 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8291 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8292 exists.
8293
8294 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8295 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8296 unobvious parameters.
8297
8298 Example :
8299 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8300 backend public_www
8301 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8302 stats enable
8303 stats hide-version
8304 stats scope .
8305 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008306 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008307 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8308 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8309
8310 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8311 backend private_monitoring
8312 stats enable
8313 stats uri /admin?stats
8314 stats refresh 5s
8315
8316 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8317
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008318
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008319stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008320 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008322 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008323
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008324 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008325 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8326
8327 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8328 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8329
8330 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8331 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008332 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008333
8334 Example :
8335 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8336 backend private_monitoring
8337 stats enable
8338 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8339 stats uri /admin?stats
8340 stats refresh 5s
8341
8342 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8343 global section.
8344
8345
8346stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008347 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8348 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8349 yes | yes | yes | yes
8350 Arguments : none
8351
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008352 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008353 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8354 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8355 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8356 - IP (socket, server)
8357 - cookie (backend, server)
8358
8359 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8360 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008361 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008362
8363 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8364
8365
8366stats show-node [ <name> ]
8367 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008369 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008370 Arguments:
8371 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8372 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8373
8374 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8375 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008376 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008377
8378 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8379 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8380 unobvious parameters.
8381
8382 Example:
8383 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8384 backend private_monitoring
8385 stats enable
8386 stats show-node Europe-1
8387 stats uri /admin?stats
8388 stats refresh 5s
8389
8390 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8391 section.
8392
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008393
8394stats uri <prefix>
8395 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008397 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008398 Arguments :
8399 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8400 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8401 query string.
8402
8403 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8404 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8405 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8406 possible to reach it in the application.
8407
8408 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008409 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008410 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8411 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8412 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8413 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8414
8415 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8416 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8417 an address or a port to statistics only.
8418
8419 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8420 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8421 unobvious parameters.
8422
8423 Example :
8424 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8425 backend public_www
8426 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8427 stats enable
8428 stats hide-version
8429 stats scope .
8430 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008431 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008432 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8433 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8434
8435 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8436 backend private_monitoring
8437 stats enable
8438 stats uri /admin?stats
8439 stats refresh 5s
8440
8441 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8442
8443
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008444stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8445 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008447 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008448
8449 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008450 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008451 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008452 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008453 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8454
8455 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8456 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8457 the "stick-table" statement.
8458
8459 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8460 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8461 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8462 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8463 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8464
8465 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8466 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8467 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8468 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8469 transformation rules.
8470
8471 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8472 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8473 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8474 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8475 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8476 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8477 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8478
8479 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8480 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8481 ACL based conditions.
8482
8483 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8484 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8485 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8486 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8487
8488 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8489 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8490 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8491 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8492
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008493 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8494 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008495 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008496
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008497 Example :
8498 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8499 # last 30 minutes
8500 backend pop
8501 mode tcp
8502 balance roundrobin
8503 stick store-request src
8504 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8505 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8506 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8507
8508 backend smtp
8509 mode tcp
8510 balance roundrobin
8511 stick match src table pop
8512 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8513 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8514
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008515 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008516 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008517
8518
8519stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8520 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8522 no | no | yes | yes
8523
8524 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8525 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8526 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8527 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8528
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008529 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8530 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008531 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008532
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008533 Examples :
8534 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008535 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008536
8537 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8538 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8539 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8540
8541
8542 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8543 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8544 backend http
8545 mode http
8546 balance roundrobin
8547 stick on src table https
8548 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8549 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8550 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8551
8552 backend https
8553 mode tcp
8554 balance roundrobin
8555 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8556 stick on src
8557 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8558 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8559
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008560 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008561
8562
8563stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8564 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8566 no | no | yes | yes
8567
8568 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008569 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008570 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008571 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008572 server is selected.
8573
8574 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8575 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8576 the "stick-table" statement.
8577
8578 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8579 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8580 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8581 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8582 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8583 address.
8584
8585 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8586 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8587 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8588 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8589 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8590 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8591 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8592 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8593 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8594 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8595
8596 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8597 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8598 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8599 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8600 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8601 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8602 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8603
8604 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8605 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8606 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8607 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8608
8609 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8610 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8611 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8612 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8613 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8614 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008615 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8616 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8617 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8618 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8619 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8620 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008621
8622 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8623 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8624 the request.
8625
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008626 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8627 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008628 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008629
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008630 Example :
8631 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8632 # last 30 minutes
8633 backend pop
8634 mode tcp
8635 balance roundrobin
8636 stick store-request src
8637 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8638 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8639 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8640
8641 backend smtp
8642 mode tcp
8643 balance roundrobin
8644 stick match src table pop
8645 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8646 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8647
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008648 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008649 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008650
8651
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008652stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008653 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8654 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008655 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008657 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008658
8659 Arguments :
8660 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8661 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8662 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8663 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8664
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008665 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8666 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8667 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8668 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8669
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008670 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8671 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8672 instance.
8673
8674 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8675 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8676 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8677 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8678 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8679 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008680 to 32 characters.
8681
8682 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8683 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8684 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008685 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008686 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8687 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008688
8689 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008690 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8691 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008692 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8693 increase.
8694
8695 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008696 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8697 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8698 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008699
8700 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8701 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8702 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8703 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008704 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008705 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8706 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8707 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8708 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8709 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8710 parameter (see below).
8711
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008712 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8713 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8714 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8715 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8716 soft restart.
8717
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008718 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8719 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008720
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008721 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8722 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8723 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8724 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008725 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008726 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008727 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8728 if not expiration delay is specified.
8729
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008730 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8731 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8732 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8733 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008734 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8735 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8736 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8737 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8738 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8739 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8740 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8741 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8742 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8743 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8744 types and their arguments.
8745
8746 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8747 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8748 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8749 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8750
8751 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8752 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8753 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008754 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008755
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008756 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8757 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8758 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008759 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008760 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008761 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008762
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01008763 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8764 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8765 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8766 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
8767
8768 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
8769 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8770 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8771 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8772 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8773 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
8774
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008775 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8776 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8777 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8778 they were received.
8779
8780 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8781 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8782 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8783 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8784 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8785
8786 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8787 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8788 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8789 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8790 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8791
8792 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8793 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8794 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8795
8796 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8797 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8798 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8799 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8800 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8801
8802 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8803 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8804 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8805 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8806 the client side.
8807
8808 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8809 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8810 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8811 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8812 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8813 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8814 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8815
8816 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8817 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8818 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8819 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8820 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8821 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008822 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008823
8824 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8825 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8826 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8827 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8828 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8829 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8830
8831 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008832 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008833 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8834 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8835
8836 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8837 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8838 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8839 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8840 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8841 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8842 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8843 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8844 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8845 recommended for better fairness.
8846
8847 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008848 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008849 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8850 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8851
8852 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8853 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8854 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8855 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8856 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8857 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8858 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8859 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8860 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8861 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008862
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008863 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8864 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008865 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8866 reference it.
8867
8868 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8869 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008870 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8871 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8872 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008873
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008874 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8875 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8876 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8877 something that can be ignored.
8878
8879 Example:
8880 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8881 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8882 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8883 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8884
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008885 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008886 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008887
8888
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008889stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008890 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8892 no | no | yes | yes
8893
8894 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008895 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008896 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008897 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008898 server is selected.
8899
8900 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8901 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8902 the "stick-table" statement.
8903
8904 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8905 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8906 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8907 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8908
8909 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8910 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8911 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8912 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8913 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8914 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008915 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008916 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8917 rules.
8918
8919 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8920 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8921 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8922 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8923 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8924 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8925 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8926
8927 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8928 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8929 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8930 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8931
8932 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8933 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8934 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8935 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8936 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8937 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008938 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8939 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8940 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8941 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8942 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8943 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8944 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8945 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8946 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008947
8948 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8949
8950 Example :
8951 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8952 backend https
8953 mode tcp
8954 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008955 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008956 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008957
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008958 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8959 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8960
8961 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8962 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8963 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8964
8965 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8966 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008967
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008968 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8969 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8970 # at offset 44.
8971
8972 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8973 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8974
8975 # Learn on response if server hello.
8976 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008977
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008978 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8979 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8980
8981 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8982 extraction.
8983
8984
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008985tcp-check connect [params*]
8986 Opens a new connection
8987 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8988 no | no | yes | yes
8989
8990 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8991 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8992 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8993
8994 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8995 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8996 of the sequence.
8997
8998 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8999 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9000 do.
9001
9002 Parameters :
9003 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9004 use the TCP connection.
9005
9006 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9007 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9008 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9009
9010 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9011
9012 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9013
9014 Examples:
9015 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9016 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9017 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9018 option tcp-check
9019 tcp-check connect
9020 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9021 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9022 tcp-check send \r\n
9023 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9024 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9025 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9026 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9027 tcp-check send \r\n
9028 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9029 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9030
9031 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9032 option tcp-check
9033 tcp-check connect port 110
9034 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9035 tcp-check connect port 143
9036 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9037 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9038
9039 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9040
9041
9042tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009043 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009044 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9045 no | no | yes | yes
9046
9047 Arguments :
9048 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9049 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9050 binary.
9051 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9052 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9053 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9054
9055 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9056 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9057 with the usual backslash ('\').
9058 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009059 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009060 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9061 used upper or lower case.
9062
9063
9064 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9065
9066 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9067 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9068 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9069 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9070 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9071 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9072 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9073 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9074
9075 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9076 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9077 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9078 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9079 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9080 expression.
9081
9082 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9083 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9084 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9085 this exact hexadecimal string.
9086 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9087
9088 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9089 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9090 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9091 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9092 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9093 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9094 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9095 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9096 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9097 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9098 the null character.
9099
9100 Examples :
9101 # perform a POP check
9102 option tcp-check
9103 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9104
9105 # perform an IMAP check
9106 option tcp-check
9107 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9108
9109 # look for the redis master server
9110 option tcp-check
9111 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009112 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009113 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9114 tcp-check expect string role:master
9115 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9116 tcp-check expect string +OK
9117
9118
9119 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9120 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9121
9122
9123tcp-check send <data>
9124 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9125 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9126 no | no | yes | yes
9127
9128 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9129 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9130
9131 Examples :
9132 # look for the redis master server
9133 option tcp-check
9134 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9135 tcp-check expect string role:master
9136
9137 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9138 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9139
9140
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009141tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9142 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009143 tcp health check
9144 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9145 no | no | yes | yes
9146
9147 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9148 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009149 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009150 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9151 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9152 hexadecimal string.
9153 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9154
9155 Examples :
9156 # redis check in binary
9157 option tcp-check
9158 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9159 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9160
9161
9162 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9163 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9164
9165
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009166tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9167 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9169 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009170 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009171 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9172 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009173
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009174 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009175
9176 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9177 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009178 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9179 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9180 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9181 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9182 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9183 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009184
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009185 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9186 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9187 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9188 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009189
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009190 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009191 - accept :
9192 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9193 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9194 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009195
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009196 - reject :
9197 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9198 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9199 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9200 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9201 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9202 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9203 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9204 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9205 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9206 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9207 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009208 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009209
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009210 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9211 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9212 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9213 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9214 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9215 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9216 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9217 hosts.
9218
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009219 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9220 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9221 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9222 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9223 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9224 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9225 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9226 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9227
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009228 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9229 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9230 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9231 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9232 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9233 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9234 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9235 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9236 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009237 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9238 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009239
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009240 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009241 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02009242 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009243 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009244 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9245 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009246 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009247 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
9248 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
9249 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
9250 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
9251 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009252
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009253 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009254 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009255 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009256 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009257 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9258 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9259 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009260
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009261 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9262 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9263 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9264 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009265
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009266 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9267 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9268 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9269 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9270 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009271 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9272 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9273 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9274 layer7 information is extracted.
9275
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009276 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9277 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9278 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9279 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9280 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009281
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009282 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9283 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9284 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9285 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9286
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009287 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9288 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9289 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9290 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9291
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009292 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9293 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9294 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9295 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9296 continues.
9297
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009298 - set-src <expr> :
9299 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9300 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9301 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9302 set-src"
9303
9304 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9305 followed by some converters.
9306
9307 Example:
9308
9309 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9310
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009311 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9312 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009313
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009314 - set-src-port <expr> :
9315 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9316 expression.
9317
9318 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9319 followed by some converters.
9320
9321 Example:
9322
9323 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9324
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009325 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9326 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9327 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009328
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009329 - set-dst <expr> :
9330 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9331 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9332 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9333 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9334 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9335
9336 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9337 followed by some converters.
9338
9339 Example:
9340
9341 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9342 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9343
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009344 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9345 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9346
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009347 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9348 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9349 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9350 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9351
9352
9353 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9354 followed by some converters.
9355
9356 Example:
9357
9358 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9359
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009360 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9361 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9362 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9363
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009364 - "silent-drop" :
9365 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009366 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009367 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9368 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9369 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9370 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9371 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009372 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9373 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009374 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9375 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009376 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009377 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9378 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9379 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9380 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9381
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009382 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9383 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9384 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009385
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009386 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9387 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9388 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009389
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009390 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009391 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009392 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009393
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009394 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9395 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9396 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009397
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009398 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009399 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9400 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009401
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009402 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9403
9404 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9405
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009406 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9407
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009408 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009409
9410
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009411tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9412 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009414 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009415 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009416 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9417 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009418
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009419 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009420
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009421 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009422 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9423 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9424 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9425 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009426
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009427 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9428 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9429 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9430 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009431 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9432 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9433 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9434 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9435 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9436 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009437 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009438 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009439
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009440 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9441 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9442 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9443 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009444
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009445 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009446 - accept : the request is accepted
9447 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9448 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009449 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009450 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009451 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009452 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009453 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009454 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009455 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009456 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009457
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009458 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9459 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009460
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009461 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9462 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9463 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9464 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9465 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9466 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009467
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009468 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009469 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9470 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009471
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009472 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009473 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9474 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9475 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9476 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009477 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9478 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9479 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009480
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009481 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009482 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9483 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9484 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009485
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009486 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009487 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9488 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009489
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009490 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9491 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009492 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009493 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9494 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009495 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009496 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009497 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009498 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9499 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009500 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009501 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9502 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009503
9504 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9505 followed by some converters.
9506
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009507 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9508 <var-name>.
9509
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009510 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9511 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9512 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9513 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9514 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9515
9516 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9517
9518 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9519
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009520 Example:
9521
9522 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009523 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009524
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009525 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009526 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9527 # and reject everything else.
9528 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9529 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009530 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009531 tcp-request content reject
9532
9533 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009534 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9535 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9536 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009537 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009538
9539 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9540 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9541 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009542 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009543 tcp-request content reject
9544
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009545 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009546 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009547 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009548 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009549 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9550 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009551
9552 Example:
9553 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9554 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009555 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009556
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009557 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009558 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009559
9560 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009561 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009562 # protecting all our sites
9563 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009564 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9565 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009566 ...
9567 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9568
9569 backend http_dynamic
9570 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009571 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009572 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009573 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009574 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009575 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009576 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009577
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009578 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009579
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009580 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9581 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009582
9583
9584tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9585 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009587 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009588 Arguments :
9589 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9590 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9591 as explained at the top of this document.
9592
9593 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9594 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9595 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9596 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9597 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9598
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009599 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9600 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9601 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9602 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9603
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009604 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9605 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009606 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009607 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009608 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9609 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9610 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9611 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009612
9613 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9614 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9615 it pass through unaffected.
9616
9617 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9618 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9619 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009620 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009621 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9622 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009623 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9624 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9625 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009626
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009627 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009628 "timeout client".
9629
9630
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009631tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9632 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9634 no | no | yes | yes
9635 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009636 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9637 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009638
9639 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9640
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009641 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009642 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9643 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009644 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9645 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009646
9647 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9648
9649 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9650 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9651 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9652 inserted.
9653
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009654 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009655 - accept :
9656 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9657 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9658 the rules evaluation.
9659
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009660 - close :
9661 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9662 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9663 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9664 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9665 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9666 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009667 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009668 protocols.
9669
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009670 - reject :
9671 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9672 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009673 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009674
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009675 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9676 Sets a variable.
9677
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009678 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9679 Unsets a variable.
9680
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009681 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9682 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9683 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9684 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9685
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009686 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9687 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9688 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9689 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9690
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009691 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9692 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9693 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9694 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9695 continues.
9696
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009697 - "silent-drop" :
9698 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009699 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009700 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9701 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9702 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9703 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9704 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009705 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9706 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009707 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9708 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009709 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009710 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9711 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9712 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9713 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9714
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009715 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
9716 Send a group of SPOE messages.
9717
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009718 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9719 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9720 for changing the default action to a reject.
9721
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009722 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9723 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9724 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9725 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009726 period.
9727
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009728 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9729 declared inline.
9730
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009731 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9732 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009733 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009734 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9735 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009736 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009737 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009738 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009739 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9740 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009741 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009742 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9743 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009744
9745 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9746 followed by some converters.
9747
9748 Example:
9749
9750 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9751
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009752 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9753 <var-name>.
9754
9755 Example:
9756
9757 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
9758
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009759 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9760 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9761 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9762 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9763 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9764
9765 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9766
9767 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9768
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009769 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9770
9771 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9772
9773
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009774tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9775 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9776 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9777 no | yes | yes | no
9778 Arguments :
9779 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9780 below.
9781
9782 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9783
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009784 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009785 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9786 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9787 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9788 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9789 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9790 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9791 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009792 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009793 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9794 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
9795 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
9796 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
9797 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
9798 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
9799 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
9800 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
9801 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
9802 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
9803 instead.
9804
9805 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9806 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9807 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
9808 rules which may be inserted.
9809
9810 Several types of actions are supported :
9811 - accept : the request is accepted
9812 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9813 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
9814 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009815 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009816 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
9817 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009818 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009819 - silent-drop
9820
9821 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
9822 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
9823 sections for a complete description.
9824
9825 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9826 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9827 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
9828
9829 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
9830 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
9831 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
9832 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
9833 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
9834
9835 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9836 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9837
9838 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9839 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
9840 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
9841
9842 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9843 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
9844 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9845
9846 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
9847 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9848 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
9849
9850 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9851 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9852 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
9853
9854 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9855
9856 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
9857
9858
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009859tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9860 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9862 no | no | yes | yes
9863 Arguments :
9864 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9865 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9866 as explained at the top of this document.
9867
9868 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9869
9870
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009871timeout check <timeout>
9872 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9873 established.
9874
9875 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9876 yes | no | yes | yes
9877 Arguments:
9878 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9879 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9880 as explained at the top of this document.
9881
9882 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9883 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009884 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009885 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009886 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9887 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9888 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009889
9890 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9891 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9892
9893 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9894 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009895 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009896
9897 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9898 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9899 forget about it.
9900
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009901 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9902 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009903
9904
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009905timeout client <timeout>
9906timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9907 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9909 yes | yes | yes | no
9910 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009911 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009912 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9913 as explained at the top of this document.
9914
9915 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9916 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9917 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009918 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
9919 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
9920 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
9921 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009922 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9923 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9924 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009925 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009926 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009927 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9928 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009929 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9930 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009931
9932 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9933 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9934 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9935 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9936 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9937 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9938
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +01009939 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +01009940
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009941 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9942 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9943 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9944
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009945 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
9946 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009947
9948
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009949timeout client-fin <timeout>
9950 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9952 yes | yes | yes | no
9953 Arguments :
9954 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9955 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9956 as explained at the top of this document.
9957
9958 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9959 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9960 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9961 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9962 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9963 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9964 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +01009965 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
9966 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
9967 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009968
9969 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9970 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9971 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9972
9973 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9974
9975
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009976timeout connect <timeout>
9977timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9978 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9980 yes | no | yes | yes
9981 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009982 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009983 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9984 as explained at the top of this document.
9985
9986 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009987 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009988 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009989 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009990 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9991 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009992
9993 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9994 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9995 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9996 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9997 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
9998 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9999
10000 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10001 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10002 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10003
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010004 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10005 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010006
10007
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010008timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10009 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10011 yes | yes | yes | yes
10012 Arguments :
10013 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10014 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10015 as explained at the top of this document.
10016
10017 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10018 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10019 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10020 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10021 once the request has started to present itself.
10022
10023 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10024 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10025 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10026 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10027 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10028
10029 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10030 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10031 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10032 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10033
10034 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10035 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010036 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010037 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10038 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010039 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010040
10041 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10042 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10043 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10044 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10045
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010046 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10047 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010048 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10049
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010050 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10051
10052
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010053timeout http-request <timeout>
10054 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010056 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010057 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010058 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010059 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10060 as explained at the top of this document.
10061
10062 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10063 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10064 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10065 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10066 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10067 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10068 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010069 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10070 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10071 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10072 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010073 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010074 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10075 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010076
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010077 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10078 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10079 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10080 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10081 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010082 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010083
10084 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10085 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010086 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010087 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10088 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10089
10090 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010091 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10092 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10093 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010094
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010095 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010096 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010097
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010098
10099timeout queue <timeout>
10100 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10102 yes | no | yes | yes
10103 Arguments :
10104 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10105 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10106 as explained at the top of this document.
10107
10108 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10109 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10110 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10111 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10112 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10113
10114 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10115 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10116 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10117 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10118
10119 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10120
10121
10122timeout server <timeout>
10123timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10124 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10126 yes | no | yes | yes
10127 Arguments :
10128 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10129 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10130 as explained at the top of this document.
10131
10132 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10133 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10134 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10135 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10136 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10137 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10138 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10139
10140 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10141 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10142 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10143 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10144 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010145 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010146 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010147 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10148 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010149 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10150 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010151
10152 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10153 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10154 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10155 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10156 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10157 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10158
10159 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10160 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10161 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10162
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010163 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010164
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010165
10166timeout server-fin <timeout>
10167 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10169 yes | no | yes | yes
10170 Arguments :
10171 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10172 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10173 as explained at the top of this document.
10174
10175 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10176 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10177 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10178 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10179 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10180 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10181 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10182 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10183 situations, it should not be needed.
10184
10185 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10186 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10187 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10188
10189 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10190
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010191
10192timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010193 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10195 yes | yes | yes | yes
10196 Arguments :
10197 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10198 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10199 as explained at the top of this document.
10200
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010201 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10202 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10203 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10204 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010205
10206 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10207 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10208 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10209 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010210 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010211
10212 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10213
10214
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010215timeout tunnel <timeout>
10216 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10217 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10218 yes | no | yes | yes
10219 Arguments :
10220 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10221 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10222 as explained at the top of this document.
10223
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010224 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010225 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10226 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10227 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010228 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10229 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010230 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10231 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10232 specified.
10233
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010234 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10235 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10236 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10237 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10238 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10239 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10240 state.
10241
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010242 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10243 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10244 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10245 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010246 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010247
10248 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10249 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10250 forget about it.
10251
10252 Example :
10253 defaults http
10254 option http-server-close
10255 timeout connect 5s
10256 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010257 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010258 timeout server 30s
10259 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10260
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010261 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010262
10263
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010264transparent (deprecated)
10265 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010267 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010268 Arguments : none
10269
10270 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10271 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10272 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10273 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10274 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10275 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10276 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10277 appropriate server.
10278
10279 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10280
10281 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10282 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10283
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010284 See also: "option transparent"
10285
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010286unique-id-format <string>
10287 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10289 yes | yes | yes | no
10290 Arguments :
10291 <string> is a log-format string.
10292
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010293 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10294 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10295 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10296 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010297
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010298 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10299 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10300 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10301 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10302 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10303 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10304 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10305 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010306
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010307 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10308 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010309
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010310 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010311
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010312 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010313
10314 will generate:
10315
10316 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10317
10318 See also: "unique-id-header"
10319
10320unique-id-header <name>
10321 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10323 yes | yes | yes | no
10324 Arguments :
10325 <name> is the name of the header.
10326
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010327 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10328 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010329
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010330 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010331
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010332 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010333 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10334
10335 will generate:
10336
10337 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10338
10339 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010340
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010341use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010342 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10344 no | yes | yes | no
10345 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010346 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10347 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010348
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010349 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10350 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010351
10352 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10353 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10354 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010355 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010356 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010357 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10358 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010359
10360 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10361 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10362 assign the backend.
10363
10364 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10365 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10366 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10367 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10368 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10369 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10370
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010371 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010372 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010373 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10374 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10375 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10376
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010377 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10378 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10379 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10380 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10381 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10382 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10383 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10384 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10385 cannot be forced from the request.
10386
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010387 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010388 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10389 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10390
10391 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10392 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010393
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010394
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010395use-server <server> if <condition>
10396use-server <server> unless <condition>
10397 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10399 no | no | yes | yes
10400 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010401 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010402
10403 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10404
10405 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10406 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10407 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10408
10409 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10410 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10411 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10412 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10413 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10414 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10415 matches will assign the server.
10416
10417 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10418 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10419 with the next rules until one matches.
10420
10421 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10422 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10423 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10424 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10425
10426 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10427 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10428 stripped.
10429
10430 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10431 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10432 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10433 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10434
10435 Example :
10436 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10437 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10438 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10439 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10440 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10441 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010442 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010443 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10444 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10445
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010446 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010447
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010448
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100104495. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010450--------------------------
10451
10452The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10453depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10454settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10455written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10456described in this section.
10457
10458
104595.1. Bind options
10460-----------------
10461
10462The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10463as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10464no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10465parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10466while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10467provided immediately after the setting name.
10468
10469The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10470
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010471accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10472 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10473 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10474 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10475 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10476 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10477 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10478 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10479 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10480 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010481 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10482 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10483 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010484
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010485accept-proxy
10486 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010487 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10488 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010489 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10490 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10491 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10492 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010493 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010494 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10495 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010496 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10497 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010498
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010499allow-0rtt
10500 Allow receiving early data when using TLS 1.3. This is disabled by default,
10501 due to security considerations.
10502
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010503alpn <protocols>
10504 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10505 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10506 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10507 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10508 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010509 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10510 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10511 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10512 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10513 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10514 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10515 preference, like below :
10516
10517 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010518
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010519backlog <backlog>
10520 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10521 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10522
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010523curves <curves>
10524 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10525 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10526 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10527 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10528 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10529 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10530
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010531ecdhe <named curve>
10532 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010533 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10534 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010535
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010536ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010537 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10538 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10539 client's certificate.
10540
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010541ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10542 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10543 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10544 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10545 error is ignored.
10546
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010547ca-sign-file <cafile>
10548 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10549 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10550 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10551 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10552 'generate-certificates' for details.
10553
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010554ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010555 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10556 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10557 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10558 'generate-certificates' for details.
10559
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010560ciphers <ciphers>
10561 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10562 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010563 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010564 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
10565 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010566 Depending on the compatibility and security requirements, the list of suitable
Daniel Schneller87e43022017-09-01 19:29:57 +020010567 ciphers depends on a variety of variables. For background information and
10568 recommendations see e. g. (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS)
10569 and (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010570
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010571crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010572 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10573 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10574 to verify client's certificate.
10575
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010576crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010577 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10578 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10579 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10580 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10581 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10582 file.
10583
10584 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10585 are loaded.
10586
10587 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010588 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010589 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10590 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10591 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10592 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010593 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10594 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010595 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010596
10597 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10598 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10599 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10600 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010601 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10602 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010603
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010604 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010605
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010606 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010607 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010608 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
10609 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010610 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10611 clients).
10612
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010613 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10614 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10615 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10616 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10617 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10618 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10619 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10620 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10621 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10622 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10623 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10624 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10625 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10626
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010627 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10628 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10629 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10630 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10631 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10632
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010633 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10634 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10635 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10636 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010637
10638 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10639 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10640 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10641 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10642 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10643 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10644 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10645 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10646 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10647
10648 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10649
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010650 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010651 a cert bundle.
10652
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010653 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010654 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10655 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10656 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10657 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10658 provide multi-cert support.
10659
10660 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10661
10662 Filename | CN | SAN
10663 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10664 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010665 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010666 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10667 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10668
10669 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10670 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10671 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10672 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010673 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
10674 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
10675 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010676
10677 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10678 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10679
10680 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10681 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10682 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10683
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010684crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010685 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010686 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010687 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010688 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010689
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010690crt-list <file>
10691 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010692 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10693 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010694
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010695 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10696
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010697 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
10698 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010699 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010700 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010701
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010702 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10703 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10704 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10705 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10706 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10707 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10708 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10709 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010710
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010711 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010712 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010713 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
10714 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
10715 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010716
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010717 crt-list file example:
10718 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010719 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010720 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010721 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010722
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010723defer-accept
10724 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10725 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10726 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010727 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010728 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10729 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10730 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10731 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10732 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10733 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10734 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10735
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010736expose-fd listeners
10737 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
10738 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020010739 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
10740 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010741 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010742
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010743force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010744 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010745 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010746 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010747 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010748
10749force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010750 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010751 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010752 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010753
10754force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010755 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010756 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010757 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010758
10759force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010760 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010761 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010762 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010763
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010764force-tlsv13
10765 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
10766 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010767 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010768
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010769generate-certificates
10770 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10771 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10772 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10773 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10774 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10775 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10776 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10777 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10778 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10779 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10780 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10781
10782 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10783 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010784 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010785 certificate is used many times.
10786
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010787gid <gid>
10788 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10789 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10790 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10791 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10792 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10793
10794group <group>
10795 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10796 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10797 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10798 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10799 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10800
10801id <id>
10802 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10803 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10804 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10805 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10806
10807interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010808 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10809 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10810 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10811 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10812 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10813 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010010814 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
10815 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
10816 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
10817 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
10818 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
10819 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010820
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010821level <level>
10822 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10823 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10824 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010825 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010826 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10827 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10828 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010829 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010830 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010831 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010832 all counters).
10833
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020010834severity-output <format>
10835 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
10836 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
10837 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
10838 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
10839 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
10840 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
10841 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
10842 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
10843 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
10844 rfc5424 convention.
10845
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010846maxconn <maxconn>
10847 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10848 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10849 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10850 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10851 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10852 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10853 eat all memory.
10854
10855mode <mode>
10856 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10857 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10858 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10859 UNIX sockets.
10860
10861mss <maxseg>
10862 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10863 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10864 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10865 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10866 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10867 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10868 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10869 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10870 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10871 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10872 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10873
10874name <name>
10875 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10876 page.
10877
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010878namespace <name>
10879 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10880 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
10881 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10882 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10883
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010884nice <nice>
10885 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
10886 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
10887 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
10888 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
10889 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
10890 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
10891 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
10892 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
10893 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
10894 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
10895 one for an RDP socket.
10896
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010897no-ca-names
10898 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10899 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
10900
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010901no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010902 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010903 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010904 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010905 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010906 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
10907 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010908
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010909no-tls-tickets
10910 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10911 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10912 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010913 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
10914 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010915
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010916no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010917 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010918 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010919 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010920 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010921 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10922 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010923
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010924no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010925 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010926 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010927 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010928 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010929 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10930 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010931
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010932no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010933 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010934 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010935 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010936 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010937 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10938 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010939
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010940no-tlsv13
10941 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10942 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
10943 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
10944 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010945 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10946 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010947
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010948npn <protocols>
10949 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
10950 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
10951 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10952 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010953 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010954 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
10955 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
10956 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
10957 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
10958 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010959
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000010960prefer-client-ciphers
10961 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
10962 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
10963 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
10964
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010010965process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
10966 This restricts the list of processes and/or threads on which this listener is
10967 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010968 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010010969 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
10970 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
10971 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
10972 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010973 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010010974 connections for this listener, for the corresponding process set. For the
10975 unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
10976 repeated. <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
10977
10978 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
10979
10980 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
10981 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
10982 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
10983 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
10984 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
10985 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
10986 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
10987 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010988
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010989ssl
10990 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010991 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010992 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
10993 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020010994 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
10995 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010996
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010997ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
10998 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
10999 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11000 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11001
11002ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11003 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11004 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11005 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11006
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011007strict-sni
11008 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11009 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11010 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11011 See the "crt" option for more information.
11012
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011013tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011014 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011015 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11016 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011017 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011018 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11019 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11020 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11021 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11022 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11023 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11024 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11025
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011026tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011027 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011028 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11029 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11030 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11031 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11032 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11033 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11034 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011035 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11036 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11037 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011038
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011039tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11040 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
11041 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
11042 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
11043 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
11044 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
11045 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
11046 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
11047 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
11048 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11049 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11050
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011051transparent
11052 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11053 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11054 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11055 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11056 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11057 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11058 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11059 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11060 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11061 so check for support with your vendor.
11062
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011063v4v6
11064 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11065 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11066 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11067 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011068 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011069
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011070v6only
11071 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11072 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11073 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011074 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11075 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011076
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011077uid <uid>
11078 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11079 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11080 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11081 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11082 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11083
11084user <user>
11085 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11086 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11087 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11088 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11089 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11090
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011091verify [none|optional|required]
11092 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11093 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11094 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11095 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11096 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011097 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11098 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11099 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11100 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011101
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200111025.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011103------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011104
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011105The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11106which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11107arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11108settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11109after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11110Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11111address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011112
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011113 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011114 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011115
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011116Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11117keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11118
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011119The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011120
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011121addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011122 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011123 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11124 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11125 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11126 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11127 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011128
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011129agent-check
11130 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011131 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
11132 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
11133 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
11134 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011135
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011136 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011137 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011138 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11139 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11140 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011141
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011142 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11143 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11144 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11145 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11146 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011147
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011148 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011149 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011150
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011151 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11152 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11153 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011154
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011155 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11156 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11157 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011158
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011159 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11160 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11161 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11162 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11163 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011164 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011165 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011166
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011167 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11168 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011169
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011170 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11171 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11172 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11173 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11174 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11175 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11176 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11177 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11178 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011179
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011180 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11181 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011182 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11183 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11184 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011185 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011186
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011187 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011188 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011189
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011190agent-send <string>
11191 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11192 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11193 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11194 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11195 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11196
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011197agent-inter <delay>
11198 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11199 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11200
11201 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11202 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11203 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11204 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11205 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11206 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11207 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11208 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11209 of backends use the same servers.
11210
11211 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11212
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011213agent-addr <addr>
11214 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11215
11216 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11217 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11218 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11219 hostname, it will be resolved.
11220
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011221agent-port <port>
11222 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11223
11224 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011226backup
11227 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11228 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11229 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11230 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011231 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11232 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011233
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011234ca-file <cafile>
11235 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11236 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11237 server's certificate.
11238
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011239check
11240 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011241 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11242 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11243 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11244 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11245 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11246 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11247 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011248 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11249 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011250 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11251 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011252
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011253check-send-proxy
11254 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11255 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11256 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11257 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11258 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11259 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11260 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11261
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011262check-sni
11263 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
11264 over SSL.
11265
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011266check-ssl
11267 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11268 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11269 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11270 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011271 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011272 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11273 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011274 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011275 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11276 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011277
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011278ciphers <ciphers>
11279 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011280 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011281 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
11282 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
11283 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
11284 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
11285 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
11286 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
11287
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011288cookie <value>
11289 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11290 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11291 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11292 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11293 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11294 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11295 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11296
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011297crl-file <crlfile>
11298 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11299 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11300 to verify server's certificate.
11301
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011302crt <cert>
11303 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11304 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11305 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11306 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11307 certificate request.
11308
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011309disabled
11310 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11311 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11312 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11313 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11314 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011315 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011316
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011317enabled
11318 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11319 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11320 default value.
11321 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11322 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011323
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011324error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011325 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11326 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11327 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011328
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011329 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011330
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011331fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011332 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11333 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11334 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11335
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011336force-sslv3
11337 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11338 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011339 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011340 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011341
11342force-tlsv10
11343 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011344 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011345 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011346
11347force-tlsv11
11348 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011349 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011350 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011351
11352force-tlsv12
11353 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011354 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011355 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011356
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011357force-tlsv13
11358 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11359 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011360 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011361
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011362id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011363 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11364 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11365 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011366
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011367init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11368 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11369 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011370 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011371 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11372 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11373 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11374 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11375 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11376 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11377 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11378 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11379 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011380 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011381 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11382 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11383 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11384 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11385 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11386 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011387 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011388
11389 Example:
11390 defaults
11391 # never fail on address resolution
11392 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11393
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011394inter <delay>
11395fastinter <delay>
11396downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011397 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11398 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11399 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11400 between checks depending on the server state :
11401
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011402 Server state | Interval used
11403 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11404 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11405 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11406 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11407 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11408 or yet unchecked. |
11409 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11410 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11411 | "inter" otherwise.
11412 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011413
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011414 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11415 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11416 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11417 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011418 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11419 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11420 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11421 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11422 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011423
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011424maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011425 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11426 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11427 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11428 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11429 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11430 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11431 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11432 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11433
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011434maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011435 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11436 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11437 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11438 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11439 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11440 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11441 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11442
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011443minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011444 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11445 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11446 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11447 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11448 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11449 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011450 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011451 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011452
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011453namespace <name>
11454 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11455 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11456 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11457 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11458
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011459no-agent-check
11460 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11461 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11462 default value.
11463 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11464 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11465
11466no-backup
11467 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11468 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11469 default value.
11470 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11471 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11472
11473no-check
11474 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11475 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11476 default value.
11477 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11478 "default-server" "check" setting.
11479
11480no-check-ssl
11481 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11482 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11483 default value.
11484 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11485 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11486
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011487no-send-proxy
11488 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11489 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11490 default value.
11491 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11492 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11493
11494no-send-proxy-v2
11495 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11496 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11497 default value.
11498 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11499 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11500
11501no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11502 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11503 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11504 default value.
11505 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11506 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11507
11508no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11509 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11510 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11511 default value.
11512 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11513 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11514
11515no-ssl
11516 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11517 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11518 default value.
11519 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11520 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11521
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011522no-ssl-reuse
11523 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11524 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11525 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11526 and for paranoid users.
11527
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011528no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011529 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11530 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011531 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011532
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011533 Supported in default-server: No
11534
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011535no-tls-tickets
11536 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11537 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11538 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011539 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11540 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011541 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011542
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011543no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011544 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011545 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11546 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011547 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11548 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011549 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011550
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011551 Supported in default-server: No
11552
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011553no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011554 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011555 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11556 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011557 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11558 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011559 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011560
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011561 Supported in default-server: No
11562
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011563no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011564 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011565 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11566 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011567 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11568 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011569 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011570
11571 Supported in default-server: No
11572
11573no-tlsv13
11574 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11575 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11576 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11577 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11578 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011579 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011580
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011581 Supported in default-server: No
11582
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011583no-verifyhost
11584 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11585 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11586 default value.
11587 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11588 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011589
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011590non-stick
11591 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11592 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11593 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11594
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011595observe <mode>
11596 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11597 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11598 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11599 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11600 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11601 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011602 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011603
11604 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11605
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011606on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011607 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11608 Currently, four modes are available:
11609 - fastinter: force fastinter
11610 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11611 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11612 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11613 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11614
11615 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11616
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011617on-marked-down <action>
11618 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11619 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011620 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11621 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11622 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11623 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11624 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11625 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11626 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11627 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011628
11629 Actions are disabled by default
11630
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011631on-marked-up <action>
11632 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11633 Currently one action is available:
11634 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11635 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11636 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11637 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011638 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11639 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011640 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11641 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11642
11643 Actions are disabled by default
11644
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011645port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011646 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11647 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11648 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11649 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11650 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11651 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11652
11653redir <prefix>
11654 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11655 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11656 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11657 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11658 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11659 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11660 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11661 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011662 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011663 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011664 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11665 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11666 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11667 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11668
11669 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11670
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011671rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011672 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11673 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11674 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11675
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011676resolve-prefer <family>
11677 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
11678 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
11679 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
11680 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
11681
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020011682 Default value: ipv6
11683
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011684 Example:
11685
11686 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011687
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011688resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
11689 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
11690 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011691 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011692 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
11693 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011694 configured network, another address is selected.
11695
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011696 Example:
11697
11698 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011699
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011700resolvers <id>
11701 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
11702 hostname.
11703
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011704 Example:
11705
11706 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011707
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011708 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011709
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011710send-proxy
11711 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
11712 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
11713 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
11714 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011715 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
11716 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
11717 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
11718 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
11719 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
11720 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
11721 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
11722 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
11723 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
11724 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011725 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
11726 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011727
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011728send-proxy-v2
11729 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
11730 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11731 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11732 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020011733 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
11734 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
11735 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
11736 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011737
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010011738proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
11739 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
11740 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010011741 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
11742 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010011743 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
11744 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010011745 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010011746
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011747send-proxy-v2-ssl
11748 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11749 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11750 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11751 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11752 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11753 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
11754 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011755 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
11756 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011757
11758send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11759 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11760 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11761 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11762 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11763 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11764 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
11765 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
11766 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011767 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
11768 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011769
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011770slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011771 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
11772 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
11773 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
11774 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
11775 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
11776 parameters :
11777
11778 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
11779 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
11780
11781 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
11782 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
11783 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
11784 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
11785
11786 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
11787 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
11788 seen as failed.
11789
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011790sni <expression>
11791 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
11792 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
11793 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
11794 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020011795 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
11796 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011797 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
11798 "verify" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011799
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011800source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011801source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011802source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011803 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
11804 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
11805 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
11806 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
11807
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011808 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
11809 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
11810 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
11811 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
11812 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
11813 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
11814 server.
11815
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000011816 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
11817 specifying the source address without port(s).
11818
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011819ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011820 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
11821 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
11822 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
11823 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
11824 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
11825 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011826 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
11827 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011828
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011829ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11830 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
11831 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
11832 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11833
11834ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11835 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
11836 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
11837 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11838
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011839ssl-reuse
11840 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
11841 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11842 default value.
11843 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11844 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
11845
11846stick
11847 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
11848 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11849 default value.
11850 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11851 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011852
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011853tcp-ut <delay>
11854 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
11855 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
11856 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011857 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011858 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
11859 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
11860 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
11861 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
11862 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
11863 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
11864 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
11865 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
11866 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11867
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011868track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020011869 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
11870 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
11871 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
11872 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011873 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
11874
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011875tls-tickets
11876 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
11877 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11878 default value.
11879 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11880 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011881
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011882verify [none|required]
11883 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010011884 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011885 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
11886 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011887 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011888 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
11889 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
11890 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
11891 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
11892 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
11893 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
11894 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
11895 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011896
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011897verifyhost <hostname>
11898 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011899 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
11900 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
11901 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
11902 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
11903 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
11904 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
11905 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
11906 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011907
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011908weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011909 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
11910 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
11911 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020011912 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
11913 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
11914 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
11915 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
11916 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
11917 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011918
11919
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200119205.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
11921-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011922
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011923HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
11924using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
11925configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011926This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
11927can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
11928workload.
11929This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
11930resolution at run time.
11931Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
11932carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
11933
11934
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200119355.3.1. Global overview
11936----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011937
11938As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
11939different steps of the process life:
11940
11941 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
11942 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
11943 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
11944
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011945 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
11946 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011947
11948A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
11949 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
11950 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
11951 resolution to know this new IP.
11952
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011953When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011954HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011955SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
11956from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
11957will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
11958will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020011959
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011960A few things important to notice:
11961 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
11962 first valid response.
11963
11964 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
11965 servers return an error.
11966
11967
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200119685.3.2. The resolvers section
11969----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011970
11971This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011972HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
11973contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011974
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011975When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
11976uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
11977is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
11978answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
11979
11980When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011981used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011982
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011983 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
11984 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
11985 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011986
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011987 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
11988 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011989
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011990 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
11991 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
11992 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011993
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011994For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
11995following scenarios are possible:
11996
11997 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
11998 ignored
11999
12000 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12001 applied
12002
12003 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12004 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12005
12006 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12007 retries the query with a new type
12008
12009 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12010 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012011
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012012As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12013a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012014<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012015
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012016
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012017resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012018 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012019
12020A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12021
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012022accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012023 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012024 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012025 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12026 by RFC 6891)
12027
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012028 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12029
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012030nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12031 DNS server description:
12032 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12033 <ip> : IP address of the server
12034 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12035
12036hold <status> <period>
12037 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12038 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012039 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012040 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012041 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12042 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12043 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12044
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012045 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012046
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012047resolution_pool_size <nb> (deprecated)
Baptiste Assmann201c07f2017-05-22 15:17:15 +020012048 Defines the number of resolutions available in the pool for this resolvers.
12049 If not defines, it defaults to 64. If your configuration requires more than
12050 <nb>, then HAProxy will return an error when parsing the configuration.
12051
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012052resolve_retries <nb>
12053 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12054 giving up.
12055 Default value: 3
12056
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012057 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12058 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12059 type.
12060
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012061timeout <event> <time>
12062 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12063 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12064 events available are:
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012065 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12066 other time applied.
12067 Default value: 1s
12068 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
12069 have been received.
12070 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012071 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12072 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12073
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012074 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012075
12076 resolvers mydns
12077 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12078 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
12079 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012080 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012081 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012082 hold other 30s
12083 hold refused 30s
12084 hold nx 30s
12085 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012086 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012087 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012088
12089
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120906. HTTP header manipulation
12091---------------------------
12092
12093In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
12094response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
12095request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
12096which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012097against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012098
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012099If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
12100to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
12101but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
12102HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
12103stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
12104because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
12105a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
12106still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020012107
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012108This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
12109in section 4.2 :
12110
12111 - reqadd <string>
12112 - reqallow <search>
12113 - reqiallow <search>
12114 - reqdel <search>
12115 - reqidel <search>
12116 - reqdeny <search>
12117 - reqideny <search>
12118 - reqpass <search>
12119 - reqipass <search>
12120 - reqrep <search> <replace>
12121 - reqirep <search> <replace>
12122 - reqtarpit <search>
12123 - reqitarpit <search>
12124 - rspadd <string>
12125 - rspdel <search>
12126 - rspidel <search>
12127 - rspdeny <search>
12128 - rspideny <search>
12129 - rsprep <search> <replace>
12130 - rspirep <search> <replace>
12131
12132With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
12133is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
12134parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
12135prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
12136Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
12137
12138 \t for a tab
12139 \r for a carriage return (CR)
12140 \n for a new line (LF)
12141 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
12142 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
12143 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
12144 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
12145 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
12146
12147The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
12148portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
12149above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
12150regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
121519 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
12152is very common to users of the "sed" program.
12153
12154The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
12155after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
12156
12157Notes related to these keywords :
12158---------------------------------
12159 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
12160 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
12161 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
12162
12163 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
12164 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
12165 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
12166
12167 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
12168 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
12169 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
12170 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
12171 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
12172
12173 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
12174 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
12175 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
12176 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
12177 useless headers before adding new ones.
12178
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012179 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012180 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
12181
12182 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
12183 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
12184 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
12185
12186 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
12187 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012188 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012189
12190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200121917. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12192----------------------------------
12193
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012194HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012195client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12196The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12197these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12198but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12199data called patterns.
12200
12201
122027.1. ACL basics
12203---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012204
12205The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12206content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12207from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12208simple :
12209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012210 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012211 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012212 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12213 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012215The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12216adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012217
12218In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12219
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012220 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012221
12222This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12223Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12224and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012225an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12226conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12227as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12228are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012229
12230ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12231'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12232which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12233
12234There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12235performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012237The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12238specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12239this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012240methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12241ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012242
12243Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12244 - boolean
12245 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12246 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12247 - string
12248 - data block
12249
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012250Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12251converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12252would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12253The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12254which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12255
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012256Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12257keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12258fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12259which are summarized in the table below :
12260
12261 +---------------------+-----------------+
12262 | Sample or converter | Default |
12263 | output type | matching method |
12264 +---------------------+-----------------+
12265 | boolean | bool |
12266 +---------------------+-----------------+
12267 | integer | int |
12268 +---------------------+-----------------+
12269 | ip | ip |
12270 +---------------------+-----------------+
12271 | string | str |
12272 +---------------------+-----------------+
12273 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12274 +---------------------+-----------------+
12275
12276Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12277matching method, see below.
12278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012279The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12280 - boolean
12281 - integer or integer range
12282 - IP address / network
12283 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12284 - regular expression
12285 - hex block
12286
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012287The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12288
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012289 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12290 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012291 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012292 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012293 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012294 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012295 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012297The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12298read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12299if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12300lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12301will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12302beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12303a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12304lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12305exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12306
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012307The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12308parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12309ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12310a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12311check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12312
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012313The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12314socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12315file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012317Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12318loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12319
12320 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12321
12322In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12323the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12324case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12325as well.
12326
12327The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12328sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12329do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12330methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12331is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012332obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012333followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12334default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12335that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12336string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12337
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012338The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12339By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12340string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12341resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12342server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
12343waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
12344flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12345function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012347There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12348sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12349be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012350
12351 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12352 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012353 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12354 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12355 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12356 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012357
12358 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12359 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012360 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012361
12362 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012363 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012364
12365 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012366 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012367
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012368 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012369 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12370
12371 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12372 binary or string samples.
12373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012374 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12375 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012377 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12378 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12379 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012381 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12382 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012384 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12385 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012386
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012387 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12388 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012389
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012390 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12391 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012392 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012394 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12395 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12396 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012397
12398For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12399request, it is possible to do :
12400
12401 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12402
12403In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12404buffer, one would use the following acl :
12405
12406 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12407
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012408On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12409possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12410
12411 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012413All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12414criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12415method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12416to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12417criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12418the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012420If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012421the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12422For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012424 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12425 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12426 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12427 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012428
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012429
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012430The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12431types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12432combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12433brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12434default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012436 +-------------------------------------------------+
12437 | Input sample type |
12438 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012439 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012440 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12441 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12442 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012443 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012444 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012445 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012446 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012447 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012448 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012449 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012450 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012451 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012452 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012453 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012454 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012455 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012456 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012457 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012458 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012459 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012460 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012461 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012462 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012463 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012464 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12465 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12466 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012467
12468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200124697.1.1. Matching booleans
12470------------------------
12471
12472In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12473Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12474When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12475that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12476
12477Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12478return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12479"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12480
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200124827.1.2. Matching integers
12483------------------------
12484
12485Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12486enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12487to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12488
12489Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12490matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12491lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012492
12493For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12494unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12495representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12496
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012497As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12498two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12499instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12500ranges and operators.
12501
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012502For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012503operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12504Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12505of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012506
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012507Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012508
12509 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12510 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12511 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12512 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12513 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12514
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012515For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012516
12517 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12518
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012519This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12520
12521 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12522
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200125247.1.3. Matching strings
12525-----------------------
12526
12527String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12528different forms :
12529
12530 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012531 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012532
12533 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012534 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012535
12536 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12537 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12538
12539 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12540 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12541
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012542 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012543 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12544 matches.
12545
12546 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12547 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12548 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012549
12550String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12551exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12552characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12553string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12554to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012555before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012556
12557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200125587.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12559---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012560
12561Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12562they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12563possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12564passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12565the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012566the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12567match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012568
12569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200125707.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12571-------------------------------------
12572
12573It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12574not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12575a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12576to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12577digits may be used upper or lower case.
12578
12579Example :
12580 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12581 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12582
12583
125847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12585---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012586
12587IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
12588netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
12589within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012590host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012591difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
12592at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
12593does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
12594parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012595
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020012596The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
12597abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
12598
12599 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12600 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
12601 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12602 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12603 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12604 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12605 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12606 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12607
12608Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12609192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12610
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012611IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12612Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12613trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12614IPv6 patterns.
12615
12616HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
12617following situations :
12618 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
12619 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
12620 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
12621 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
12622 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
12623 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
12624 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
12625 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
12626 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
12627 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
12628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012629
126307.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
12631----------------------------------
12632
12633Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
12634combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
12635
12636 - AND (implicit)
12637 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
12638 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012640A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012642 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012644Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
12645indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012647For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
12648"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
12649requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
12650is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
12651
12652 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012653 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
12654 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
12655 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012656
12657To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
12658and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
12659
12660 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
12661 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
12662 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
12663 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
12664
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012665 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012666 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
12667 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
12668 use_backend www if host_www
12669
12670It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
12671expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
12672be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
12673the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
12674
12675 The following rule :
12676
12677 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012678 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012679
12680 Can also be written that way :
12681
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012682 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012683
12684It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
12685to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
12686simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
12687sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
12688good use is the following :
12689
12690 With named ACLs :
12691
12692 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
12693 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
12694 monitor fail if site_dead
12695
12696 With anonymous ACLs :
12697
12698 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
12699
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012700See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
12701keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012702
12703
127047.3. Fetching samples
12705---------------------
12706
12707Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
12708against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
12709sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
12710ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
12711of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
12712available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
12713
12714This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
12715Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
12716compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
12717deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
12718
12719The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
12720matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
12721method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
12722indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
12723
12724As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
12725when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
12726mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
12727the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
12728ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
12729
12730Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
12731multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
12732when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012733incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
12734are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012735is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
12736all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
12737
12738Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
12739 - name
12740 - name(arg1)
12741 - name(arg1,arg2)
12742
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012743
127447.3.1. Converters
12745-----------------
12746
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012747Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
12748of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
12749is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
12750was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012751has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012752unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
12753
12754These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
12755sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
12756the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012757support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012758
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012759A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
12760support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
12761supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
12762(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
12763bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
12764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012765The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012766
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001276751d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
12768 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
12769 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
12770 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
12771 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
12772 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
12773
12774 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012775 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
12776 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000012777 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
12778 frontend http-in
12779 bind *:8081
12780 default_backend servers
12781 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
12782 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
12783
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012784add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012785 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012786 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012787 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
12788 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012789 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012790 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12791 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12792 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12793 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012794 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012795 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012796
12797and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012798 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012799 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012800 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12801 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012802 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012803 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12804 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12805 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12806 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012807 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012808 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012809
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020012810b64dec
12811 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
12812 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
12813
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020012814base64
12815 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012816 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020012817 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
12818
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012819bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012820 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012821 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012822 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012823 presence of a flag).
12824
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012825bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
12826 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
12827 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012828 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012829
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010012830concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
12831 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
12832 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
12833 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
12834 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
12835 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
12836 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
12837 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
12838 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
12839 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
12840 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
12841 other variables, such as colon-delimited varlues. Note that due to the config
12842 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
12843 delimitors.
12844
12845 Example:
12846 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
12847 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
12848 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
12849 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
12850
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012851cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012852 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
12853 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012854
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012855crc32([<avalanche>])
12856 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
12857 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12858 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12859 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12860 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12861 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
12862 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
12863 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
12864 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
12865 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010012866 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
12867
12868crc32c([<avalanche>])
12869 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
12870 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12871 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12872 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
12873 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
12874 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
12875 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
12876 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012877
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010012878da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012879 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
12880 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
12881 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
12882 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012883 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012884 configuration language.
12885
12886 Example:
12887 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020012888 bind *:8881
12889 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012890 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012891
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020012892debug
12893 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
12894 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
12895 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
12896
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012897div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012898 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12899 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012900 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012901 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12902 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012903 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012904 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12905 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12906 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12907 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012908 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012909 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012910
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012911djb2([<avalanche>])
12912 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
12913 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12914 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12915 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12916 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12917 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12918 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010012919 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
12920 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012921
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012922even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012923 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012924 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
12925
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020012926field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
12927 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
12928 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
12929 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
12930 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
12931 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
12932 fields.
12933
12934 Example :
12935 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
12936 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
12937 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
12938 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
12939 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010012940
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012941hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012942 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012943 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012944 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012945 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010012946
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020012947hex2i
12948 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
12949 integer. If the input value can not be converted, then zero is returned.
12950
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012951http_date([<offset>])
12952 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12953 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
12954 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
12955 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
12956 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
12957 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012958
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012959in_table(<table>)
12960 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12961 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
12962 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012963 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012964 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
12965
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010012966ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
12967 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012968 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010012969 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
12970 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
12971 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
12972 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
12973 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012974
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012975json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012976 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012977 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012978 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012979 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
12980 of errors:
12981 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
12982 bytes, ...)
12983 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
12984 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
12985
12986 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
12987 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
12988 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
12989 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
12990 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
12991 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012992 - "ascii" : never fails;
12993 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
12994 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012995 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012996 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012997 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
12998 characters corresponding to the other errors.
12999
13000 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013001 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013002
13003 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013004 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013005 capture request header user-agent len 150
13006 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013007
13008 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13009 GET / HTTP/1.0
13010 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13011
13012 Output log:
13013 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13014
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013015language(<value>[,<default>])
13016 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13017 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13018 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13019 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13020 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13021 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13022 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13023 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13024 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013025 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013026 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13027 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013028
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013029 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013030
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013031 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13032 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013033
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013034 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13035 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13036 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13037 use_backend spanish if es
13038 use_backend french if fr
13039 use_backend english if en
13040 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013041
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013042length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013043 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13044 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13045 type. The result is of type integer.
13046
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013047lower
13048 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13049 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13050 type. The result is of type string.
13051
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013052ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13053 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13054 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13055 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13056 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13057 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13058 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13059
13060 Example :
13061
13062 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013063 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013064 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13065
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013066map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13067map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13068map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13069 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13070 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13071 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13072 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13073 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13074 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13075 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13076 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013077
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013078 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13079 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13080 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013081
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013082 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013083 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013084
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013085 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13086 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13087 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13088 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013089 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13090 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013091 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13092 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13093 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13094 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13095 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13096 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13097 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13098 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013099 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13100 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13101 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013102 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13103 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13104 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13105 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13106 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013107
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013108 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13109 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13110 the corresponding match text.
13111
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013112 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13113 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13114 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13115 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13116 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013117
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013118 Example :
13119
13120 # this is a comment and is ignored
13121 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13122 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13123 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13124 | | | `---------- value
13125 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13126 | `---------------------------- key
13127 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13128
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013129mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013130 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13131 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013132 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013133 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013134 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013135 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13136 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13137 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13138 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013139 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013140 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013141
13142mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013143 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013144 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13145 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013146 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013147 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013148 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013149 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13150 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13151 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13152 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013153 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013154 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013155
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013156nbsrv
13157 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13158 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13159 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13160 map lookup.
13161
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013162neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013163 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13164 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13165 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13166 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013167
13168not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013169 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013170 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013171 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013172 absence of a flag).
13173
13174odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013175 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013176 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13177
13178or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013179 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013180 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013181 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13182 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013183 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013184 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13185 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13186 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13187 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013188 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013189 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013190
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013191regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013192 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13193 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13194 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13195 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13196 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13197 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13198 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13199 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13200 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13201 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013202 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13203 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13204 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13205 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013206
13207 Example :
13208
13209 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13210 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13211 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13212 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13213
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013214capture-req(<id>)
13215 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13216 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13217
13218 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013219 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13220 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013221
13222capture-res(<id>)
13223 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13224 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13225
13226 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013227 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13228 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013229
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013230sdbm([<avalanche>])
13231 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13232 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13233 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13234 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13235 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13236 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13237 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013238 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13239 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013240
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013241set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013242 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13243 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13244 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013245 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013246 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13247 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013248 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013249 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13250 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013251 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013252 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013253
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013254sha1
13255 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
13256 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13257
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013258strcmp(<var>)
13259 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13260 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13261 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13262 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13263 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13264 shorter).
13265
13266 Example :
13267
13268 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13269 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13270 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13271
13272
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013273sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013274 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13275 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013276 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013277 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13278 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013279 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013280 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13281 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013282 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013283 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13284 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013285 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013286 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013287
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013288table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13289 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13290 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13291 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13292 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13293 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13294 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13295
13296
13297table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13298 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13299 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13300 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13301 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13302 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13303 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13304
13305table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13306 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13307 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013308 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013309 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13310 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13311
13312table_conn_cur(<table>)
13313 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13314 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13315 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13316 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13317 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13318
13319table_conn_rate(<table>)
13320 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13321 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13322 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13323 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13324 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13325
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013326table_gpt0(<table>)
13327 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13328 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13329 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13330 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13331 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13332
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013333table_gpc0(<table>)
13334 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13335 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13336 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13337 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13338 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13339
13340table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13341 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13342 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13343 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13344 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13345 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13346 sample fetch keyword.
13347
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013348table_gpc1(<table>)
13349 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13350 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13351 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
13352 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13353 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
13354
13355table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
13356 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13357 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13358 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
13359 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13360 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
13361 sample fetch keyword.
13362
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013363table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13364 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13365 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013366 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013367 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13368 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13369
13370table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13371 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13372 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13373 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13374 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13375 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13376 keyword.
13377
13378table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13379 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13380 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013381 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013382 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13383 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13384
13385table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13386 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13387 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13388 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13389 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13390 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13391 keyword.
13392
13393table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13394 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13395 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013396 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013397 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13398 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13399 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13400 keyword.
13401
13402table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13403 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13404 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013405 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013406 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13407 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13408 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13409 keyword.
13410
13411table_server_id(<table>)
13412 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13413 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13414 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13415 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13416 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13417 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13418
13419table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13420 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13421 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013422 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013423 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13424 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13425 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13426 keyword.
13427
13428table_sess_rate(<table>)
13429 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13430 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13431 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13432 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13433 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13434 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13435 keyword.
13436
13437table_trackers(<table>)
13438 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13439 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13440 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13441 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13442 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13443 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13444 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13445 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13446 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13447 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13448
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013449upper
13450 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13451 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13452 type. The result is of type string.
13453
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013454url_dec
13455 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13456 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13457
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013458unset-var(<var name>)
13459 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13460 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13461 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13462 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13463 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13464 response),
13465 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13466 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13467 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13468 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13469
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013470utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13471 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13472 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
13473 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13474 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13475 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13476 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
13477
13478 Example :
13479
13480 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013481 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013482 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13483
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013484word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13485 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
13486 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
13487 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
13488 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
13489 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
13490
13491 Example :
13492 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
13493 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13494 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
13495 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
13496 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010013497
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013498wt6([<avalanche>])
13499 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
13500 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13501 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13502 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13503 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13504 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13505 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013506 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
13507 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013508
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013509xor(<value>)
13510 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013511 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013512 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013513 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013514 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013515 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13516 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013517 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013518 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13519 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013520 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013521 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013522
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010013523xxh32([<seed>])
13524 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
13525 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13526 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13527 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13528 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13529 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13530 as cryptographically secure.
13531
13532xxh64([<seed>])
13533 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
13534 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13535 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13536 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13537 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13538 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13539 as cryptographically secure.
13540
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013541
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200135427.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013543--------------------------------------------
13544
13545A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
13546not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
13547"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
13548The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
13549
13550always_false : boolean
13551 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13552 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13553
13554always_true : boolean
13555 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13556 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13557
13558avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013559 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013560 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
13561 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
13562 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
13563 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
13564 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
13565 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
13566 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
13567 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
13568 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
13569 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
13570 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
13571 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
13572 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010013573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013574be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013575 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
13576 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
13577 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
13578 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
13579 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013581be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
13582 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13583 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13584 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013585 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013586 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
13587 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013588
13589 Example :
13590 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
13591 backend dynamic
13592 mode http
13593 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
13594 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013595
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013596bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013597 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
13598 of the string.
13599
13600bool(<bool>) : bool
13601 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
13602 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
13603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013604connslots([<backend>]) : integer
13605 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013606 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013607 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
13608 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050013609
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013610 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013611 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013612 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
13613
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013614 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
13615 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013616
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013617 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013618 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013619 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013620 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013621 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013622 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013623 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013624
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013625 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
13626 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013627 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013628 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013629
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013630date([<offset>]) : integer
13631 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
13632 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
13633 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
13634 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020013635 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
13636
13637 Example :
13638
13639 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
13640 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013641
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010013642date_us : integer
13643 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
13644 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
13645 from the same timeval structure.
13646
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020013647distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
13648 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
13649 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
13650 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
13651 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
13652 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
13653 list of supported tokens.
13654
13655distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
13656 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
13657 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
13658 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
13659 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
13660 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
13661 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
13662 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
13663 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
13664 supported tokens.
13665
13666 Example :
13667 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
13668 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
13669 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
13670 # send large files to the big farm
13671 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
13672
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020013673env(<name>) : string
13674 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
13675 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
13676 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
13677 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
13678 certain way.
13679
13680 Examples :
13681 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
13682 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
13683
13684 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
13685 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
13686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013687fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
13688 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013689 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
13690 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013691 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
13692 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013693 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013694 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
13695 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013696
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020013697fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13698 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
13699 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
13700 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
13701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013702fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13703 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13704 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13705 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
13706 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
13707 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
13708 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
13709 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
13710 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013711
13712 Example :
13713 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
13714 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
13715 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
13716 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
13717 frontend mail
13718 bind :25
13719 mode tcp
13720 maxconn 100
13721 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
13722 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
13723 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
13724 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013725
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010013726hostname : string
13727 Returns the system hostname.
13728
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013729int(<integer>) : signed integer
13730 Returns a signed integer.
13731
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013732ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
13733 Returns an ipv4.
13734
13735ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
13736 Returns an ipv6.
13737
13738meth(<method>) : method
13739 Returns a method.
13740
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013741nbproc : integer
13742 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
13743 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
13744 and debugging purposes.
13745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013746nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
13747 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
13748 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
13749 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013750 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
13751 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
13752 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013753
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013754proc : integer
13755 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
13756 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
13757 debugging purposes.
13758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013759queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013760 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
13761 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
13762 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013763 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
13764 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
13765 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
13766 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
13767 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
13768
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010013769rand([<range>]) : integer
13770 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
13771 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
13772 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
13773 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
13774 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
13775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013776srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13777 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13778 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
13779 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
13780 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
13781 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
13782 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
13783 methods.
13784
13785srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
13786 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
13787 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
13788 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013789 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013790 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
13791 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
13792 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
13793
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020013794srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13795 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
13796 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
13797 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
13798 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
13799 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
13800 fetch methods.
13801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013802srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13803 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13804 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013805 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013806 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
13807 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013808 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013809 overloading servers).
13810
13811 Example :
13812 # Redirect to a separate back
13813 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
13814 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
13815 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
13816
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013817stopping : boolean
13818 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
13819 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
13820 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
13821
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013822str(<string>) : string
13823 Returns a string.
13824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013825table_avl([<table>]) : integer
13826 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
13827 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
13828
13829table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13830 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
13831 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
13832 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
13833
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010013834thread : integer
13835 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
13836 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
13837 and debugging purposes.
13838
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013839var(<var-name>) : undefined
13840 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013841 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
13842 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013843 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013844 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13845 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013846 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013847 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13848 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013849 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013850 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013851
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200138527.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013853----------------------------------
13854
13855The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
13856closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
13857methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
13858sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
13859TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013860the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
13861counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
13862"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013863argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
13864the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
13865this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013866
13867be_id : integer
13868 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
13869 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13870
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013871be_name : string
13872 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
13873 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013875dst : ip
13876 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
13877 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
13878 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
13879 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
13880 RFC 4291.
13881
13882dst_conn : integer
13883 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13884 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
13885 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
13886 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
13887 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
13888 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
13889 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
13890 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013891
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013892dst_is_local : boolean
13893 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
13894 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
13895 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
13896 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013897 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013898 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
13899 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
13900 it only once per connection.
13901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013902dst_port : integer
13903 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
13904 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
13905 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
13906 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
13907 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
13908 an HTTP header.
13909
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020013910fc_http_major : integer
13911 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
13912 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
13913 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
13914
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010013915fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
13916 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
13917 header.
13918
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020013919fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
13920 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
13921 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
13922 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
13923 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13924 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13925 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13926
13927fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
13928 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
13929 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
13930 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
13931 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13932 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13933 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13934
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070013935fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
13936 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13937 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13938 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13939 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13940
13941fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
13942 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13943 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13944 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13945 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13946
13947fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
13948 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
13949 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13950 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13951 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13952
13953fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
13954 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
13955 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13956 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13957 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13958
13959fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
13960 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
13961 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13962 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13963 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13964
13965fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
13966 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
13967 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13968 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13969 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13970
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020013971fe_defbe : string
13972 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
13973 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
13974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013975fe_id : integer
13976 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010013977 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013978 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13979
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013980fe_name : string
13981 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
13982 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
13983 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13984
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013985sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013986sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13987sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13988sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013989 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
13990 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13991 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
13992
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013993sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013994sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13995sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13996sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013997 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
13998 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13999 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14000
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014001sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014002sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14003sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14004sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014005 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14006 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014007 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14008 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14009 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014010
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014011 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014012 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14013 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014014 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14015 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14016 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014017 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14018 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14019
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014020sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14021sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14022sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14023sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14024 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14025 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14026 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14027 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14028 when a first ACL was verified.
14029
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014030sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014031sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14032sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14033sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014034 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014035 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14036
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014037sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014038sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14039sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14040sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014041 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14042 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14043 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14044
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014045sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014046sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14047sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14048sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014049 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14050 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14051 See also src_conn_rate.
14052
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014053sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014054sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14055sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14056sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014057 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014058 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014059
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014060sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14061sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14062sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14063sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14064 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14065 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14066
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014067sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14068sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14069sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14070sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14071 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14072 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14073
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014074sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014075sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14076sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14077sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014078 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14079 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14080 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014081 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14082 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14083 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014084
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014085sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14086sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14087sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14088sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14089 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14090 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14091 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14092 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14093 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14094 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14095
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014096sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014097sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14098sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14099sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014100 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014101 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14102 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14103
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014104sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014105sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14106sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14107sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014108 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14109 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14110 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14111 src_http_err_rate.
14112
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014113sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014114sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14115sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14116sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014117 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014118 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14119 src_http_req_cnt.
14120
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014121sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014122sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14123sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14124sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014125 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14126 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14127 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14128 src_http_req_rate.
14129
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014130sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014131sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14132sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14133sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014134 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014135 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14136 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14137 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14138 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014139
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014140 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014141 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14142 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014143 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14144
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014145sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14146sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14147sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14148sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14149 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
14150 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14151 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14152 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14153 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
14154
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014155sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014156sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14157sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14158sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014159 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
14160 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14161 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014162
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014163sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014164sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14165sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14166sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014167 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
14168 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14169 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014170
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014171sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014172sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14173sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14174sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014175 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014176 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
14177 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
14178 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014179 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014180 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
14181
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014182sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014183sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14184sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14185sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014186 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
14187 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14188 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
14189 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
14190 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014191 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014192
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014193sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014194sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14195sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14196sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020014197 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
14198 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
14199 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
14200
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014201sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014202sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14203sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14204sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014205 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14206 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014207 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014208 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
14209 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014210 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
14211 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
14212 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014214so_id : integer
14215 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
14216 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
14217 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014219src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014220 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014221 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
14222 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
14223 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014224 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
14225 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
14226 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
14227 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014228
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014229 Example:
14230 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
14231 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
14232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014233src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14234 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
14235 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
14236 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014237 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014239src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14240 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
14241 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014242 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014243 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014245src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14246 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14247 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14248 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14249 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14250 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14251 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014252
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014253 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014254 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14255 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
14256 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
14257 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014258 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014259 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14260 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14261
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014262src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14263 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14264 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14265 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14266 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14267 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14268 was verified.
14269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014270src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014271 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014272 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014273 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014274 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014276src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014277 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014278 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14279 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014280 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014282src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14283 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
14284 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14285 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014286 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014288src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014289 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014290 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014291 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014292 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014293
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014294src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14295 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14296 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14297 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14298 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
14299
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014300src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14301 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14302 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14303 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14304 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
14305
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014306src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014307 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014308 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014309 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14310 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014311 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14312 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14313 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014314
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014315src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14316 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14317 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14318 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14319 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14320 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14321 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14322 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014324src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014325 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014326 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014327 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014328 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014329 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014331src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14332 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
14333 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14334 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14335 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014336 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014338src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014339 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014340 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14341 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014342 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014344src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14345 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
14346 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14347 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014348 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014349 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014351src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14352 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14353 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14354 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014355 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014356 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14357 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014358
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014359 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014360 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014361 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014362 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014363
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014364src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14365 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14366 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14367 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
14368 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14369 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14370 connection when a first ACL was verified.
14371
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014372src_is_local : boolean
14373 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
14374 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
14375 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
14376 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014377 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014378 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
14379 once per connection.
14380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014381src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014382 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
14383 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
14384 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
14385 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
14386 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014388src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014389 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
14390 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14391 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
14392 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
14393 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014395src_port : integer
14396 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
14397 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
14398 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
14399 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014401src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014402 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014403 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14404 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
14405 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014406 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014408src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14409 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
14410 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14411 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14412 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014413 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014415src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14416 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
14417 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
14418 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
14419 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
14420 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
14421 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
14422 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
14423 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014424
14425 Example :
14426 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
14427 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
14428 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
14429 listen ssh
14430 bind :22
14431 mode tcp
14432 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014433 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014434 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014435 server local 127.0.0.1:22
14436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014437srv_id : integer
14438 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
14439 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
14440 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020014441
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200144427.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014443----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020014444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014445The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
14446closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
14447when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
14448usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014449future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020014450
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001445151d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
14452 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14453 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14454 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
14455 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14456 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14457
14458 Example :
14459 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
14460 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
14461 # the request.
14462 frontend http-in
14463 bind *:8081
14464 default_backend servers
14465 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14466 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14467
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014468ssl_bc : boolean
14469 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14470 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
14471 other a server with the "ssl" option.
14472
14473ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
14474 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
14475 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14476
14477ssl_bc_cipher : string
14478 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
14479 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14480
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010014481ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
14482 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14483 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
14484 session or a TLS ticket.
14485
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014486ssl_bc_protocol : string
14487 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
14488 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14489
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014490ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014491 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014492 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14493 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014494
14495ssl_bc_session_id : binary
14496 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
14497 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
14498 if session was reused or not.
14499
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040014500ssl_bc_session_key : binary
14501 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
14502 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
14503 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
14504 BoringSSL.
14505
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014506ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
14507 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
14508 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014510ssl_c_ca_err : integer
14511 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14512 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
14513 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
14514 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
14515 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020014516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014517ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
14518 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14519 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
14520 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
14521 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014522
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010014523ssl_c_der : binary
14524 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
14525 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14526 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
14527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014528ssl_c_err : integer
14529 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14530 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
14531 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
14532 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
14533 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014535ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14536 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14537 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
14538 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14539 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14540 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14541 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14542 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14543 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014545ssl_c_key_alg : string
14546 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
14547 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14548 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014550ssl_c_notafter : string
14551 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
14552 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14553 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020014554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014555ssl_c_notbefore : string
14556 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
14557 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14558 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010014559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014560ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14561 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14562 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
14563 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14564 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14565 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14566 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14567 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14568 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010014569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014570ssl_c_serial : binary
14571 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
14572 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14573 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014575ssl_c_sha1 : binary
14576 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
14577 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
14578 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020014579 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
14580 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
14581
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014582 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020014583 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014585ssl_c_sig_alg : string
14586 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
14587 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14588 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014590ssl_c_used : boolean
14591 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
14592 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014594ssl_c_verify : integer
14595 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
14596 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
14597 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
14598 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014600ssl_c_version : integer
14601 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
14602 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014603
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010014604ssl_f_der : binary
14605 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
14606 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14607 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
14608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014609ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14610 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14611 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
14612 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14613 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014614 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014615 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14616 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14617 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014619ssl_f_key_alg : string
14620 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
14621 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
14622 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014623
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014624ssl_f_notafter : string
14625 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
14626 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14627 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014629ssl_f_notbefore : string
14630 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
14631 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14632 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014634ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14635 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14636 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
14637 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14638 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14639 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14640 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14641 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14642 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014644ssl_f_serial : binary
14645 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14646 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14647 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014648
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020014649ssl_f_sha1 : binary
14650 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
14651 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
14652 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
14653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014654ssl_f_sig_alg : string
14655 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
14656 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14657 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014659ssl_f_version : integer
14660 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14661 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14662
14663ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014664 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14665 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
14666 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
14667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014668 Example :
14669 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
14670 listen http-https
14671 bind :80
14672 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
14673 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
14674
14675ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
14676 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
14677 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14678
14679ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014680 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014681 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
14682 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
14683 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
14684 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
14685 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
14686 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
14687 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
14688 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
14689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014690ssl_fc_cipher : string
14691 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
14692 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014693
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014694ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
14695 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
14696 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014697 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014698
14699ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
14700 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
14701 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014702 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014703
14704ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
14705 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
14706 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
14707 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014708 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020014709 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014710
14711ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
14712 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
14713 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014714 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014716ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014717 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
14718 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010014719 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
14720 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
14721 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
14722 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014723
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020014724ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
14725 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
14726 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
14727 wait until the handshake happened.
14728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014729ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
14730 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020014731 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
14732 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
14733 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14734 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014735
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020014736ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020014737 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010014738 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
14739 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020014740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014741ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014742 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014743 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
14744 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
14745 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14746 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
14747 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
14748 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
14749 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020014750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014751ssl_fc_protocol : string
14752 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
14753 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014754
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014755ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014756 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014757 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14758 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014760ssl_fc_session_id : binary
14761 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
14762 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
14763 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
14764 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014765
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040014766ssl_fc_session_key : binary
14767 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
14768 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
14769 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
14770 BoringSSL.
14771
14772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014773ssl_fc_sni : string
14774 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
14775 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
14776 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
14777 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
14778 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
14779
14780 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
14781 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
14782 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020014783 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
14784 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014786 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014787 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
14788 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020014789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014790ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
14791 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
14792 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014793
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014794
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200147957.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014796------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014798Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
14799sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
14800only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
14801For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
14802be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
14803can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
14804sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
14805for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
14806content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014808payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014809 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014810 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
14811 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014813payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
14814 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014815 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014816 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014817
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020014818req.hdrs : string
14819 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
14820 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
14821 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
14822 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
14823
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020014824req.hdrs_bin : binary
14825 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
14826 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
14827 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
14828 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
14829 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
14830 names and values (length of 0 for both).
14831
14832 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
14833
14834 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
14835 str: <int:length><bytes>
14836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014837req.len : integer
14838req_len : integer (deprecated)
14839 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14840 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14841 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14842 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14843 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14844 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14845 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
14846 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014848req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14849 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014850 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14851 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14852 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14853 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014855 ACL alternatives :
14856 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014858req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14859 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14860 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14861 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
14862 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014864 ACL alternatives :
14865 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014867 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014869req.proto_http : boolean
14870req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
14871 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
14872 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
14873 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
14874 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
14875 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
14876 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
14877 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014879 Example:
14880 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
14881 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14882 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014883 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014884
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014885req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
14886rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14887 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
14888 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
14889 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
14890 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
14891 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
14892 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
14893 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014895 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
14896 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
14897 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
14898 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
14899 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
14900 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014902 ACL derivatives :
14903 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014905 Example :
14906 listen tse-farm
14907 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
14908 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
14909 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14910 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
14911 # apply RDP cookie persistence
14912 persist rdp-cookie
14913 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
14914 # This is only useful makes sense if
14915 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
14916 stick-table type string size 204800
14917 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
14918 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
14919 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014921 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
14922 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014924req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
14925rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
14926 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
14927 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
14928 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
14929 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014931 ACL derivatives :
14932 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014933
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014934req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
14935 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
14936 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014937 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
14938 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
14939 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
14940 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
14941 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014943req.ssl_hello_type : integer
14944req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14945 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14946 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
14947 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14948 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14949 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
14950 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14951 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014953req.ssl_sni : string
14954req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
14955 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
14956 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
14957 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
14958 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14959 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14960 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
14961 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
14962 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
14963 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
14964 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
14965 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
14966 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014968 ACL derivatives :
14969 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014971 Examples :
14972 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
14973 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14974 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
14975 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
14976 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014977
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053014978req.ssl_st_ext : integer
14979 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
14980 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
14981 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
14982 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
14983 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
14984 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
14985 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
14986 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
14987 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
14988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014989req.ssl_ver : integer
14990req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
14991 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
14992 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
14993 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
14994 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
14995 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14996 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14997 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014998 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014999 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015001 ACL derivatives :
15002 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015003
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015004res.len : integer
15005 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15006 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15007 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15008 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15009 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15010 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15011 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15012 content inspection.
15013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015014res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15015 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015016 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15017 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15018 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15019 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015021res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15022 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15023 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15024 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15025 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015027 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015028
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015029res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15030rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15031 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15032 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15033 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15034 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15035 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15036 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15037 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15038
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015039wait_end : boolean
15040 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15041 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015042 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015043 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15044 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015045 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015046 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15047 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015049 Examples :
15050 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15051 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15052 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015054 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15055 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15056 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15057 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15058 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15059 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15060 tcp-request content reject
15061
15062
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200150637.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015064--------------------------------------
15065
15066It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15067This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15068data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15069its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15070HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15071content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15072to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15073more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15074response are indexed.
15075
15076base : string
15077 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15078 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15079 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15080 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15081 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15082 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15083 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15084 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
15085
15086 ACL derivatives :
15087 base : exact string match
15088 base_beg : prefix match
15089 base_dir : subdir match
15090 base_dom : domain match
15091 base_end : suffix match
15092 base_len : length match
15093 base_reg : regex match
15094 base_sub : substring match
15095
15096base32 : integer
15097 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
15098 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
15099 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015100 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
15101 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
15102 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015103
15104base32+src : binary
15105 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
15106 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
15107 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
15108 per-URL counters.
15109
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015110capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
15111 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
15112 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15113 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
15114
15115capture.req.method : string
15116 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
15117 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
15118 because it's allocated.
15119
15120capture.req.uri : string
15121 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
15122 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
15123 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
15124 allocated.
15125
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015126capture.req.ver : string
15127 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15128 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
15129 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
15130
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015131capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
15132 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
15133 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15134 The first entry is an index of 0.
15135 See also: "capture response header"
15136
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015137capture.res.ver : string
15138 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15139 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
15140 persistent flag.
15141
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015142req.body : binary
15143 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
15144 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15145 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
15146 the first chunk is analyzed.
15147
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020015148req.body_param([<name>) : string
15149 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
15150 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
15151 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
15152 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
15153 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
15154 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
15155 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
15156 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
15157 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
15158 given.
15159
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015160req.body_len : integer
15161 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
15162 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
15163 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15164 "option http-buffer-request".
15165
15166req.body_size : integer
15167 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
15168 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
15169 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
15170 that the request body has been buffered made available using
15171 "option http-buffer-request".
15172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015173req.cook([<name>]) : string
15174cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15175 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15176 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15177 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
15178 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
15179 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
15180 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
15181 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
15182 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
15183
15184 ACL derivatives :
15185 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
15186 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
15187 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
15188 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
15189 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
15190 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
15191 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
15192 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015194req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15195cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15196 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15197 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015199req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15200cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15201 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15202 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
15203 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
15204 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015206cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15207 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15208 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
15209 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
15210 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015211 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015212 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
15213 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
15214 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
15215 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015217hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15218 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
15219 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
15220 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
15221 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015222 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015224req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
15225 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15226 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15227 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15228 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15229 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15230 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
15231 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
15232 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015233
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015234req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15235 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15236 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15237 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15238 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015240req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15241 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15242 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15243 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15244 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15245 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15246 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
15247 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
15248 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000015249 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015250 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015251 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015253 ACL derivatives :
15254 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15255 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15256 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15257 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15258 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15259 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15260 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15261 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15262
15263req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15264hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
15265 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15266 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
15267 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
15268 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
15269 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
15270 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
15271 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
15272 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
15273 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
15274
15275req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15276hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15277 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
15278 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
15279 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
15280 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15281 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015282 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015283 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
15284 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
15285
15286req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15287hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15288 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
15289 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
15290 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
15291 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15292 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15293 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15294 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
15295
15296http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
15297 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
15298 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
15299 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15300 basic auth is supported.
15301
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015302http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
15303 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
15304 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
15305 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
15306 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015307 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15308 basic auth is supported.
15309
15310 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015311 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
15312 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
15313 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
15314 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015315
15316http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015317 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
15318 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015319 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
15320 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015321
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015322method : integer + string
15323 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
15324 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
15325 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
15326 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
15327 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
15328 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
15329 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015331 ACL derivatives :
15332 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015334 Example :
15335 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
15336 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
15337 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015339path : string
15340 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
15341 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
15342 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
15343 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
15344 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015345 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015346 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015348 ACL derivatives :
15349 path : exact string match
15350 path_beg : prefix match
15351 path_dir : subdir match
15352 path_dom : domain match
15353 path_end : suffix match
15354 path_len : length match
15355 path_reg : regex match
15356 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015357
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010015358query : string
15359 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
15360 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
15361 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
15362 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015363 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010015364 which stops before the question mark.
15365
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010015366req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
15367 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
15368 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
15369 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
15370 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
15371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015372req.ver : string
15373req_ver : string (deprecated)
15374 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
15375 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
15376 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015378 ACL derivatives :
15379 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015381res.comp : boolean
15382 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
15383 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
15384 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015386res.comp_algo : string
15387 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
15388 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
15389 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015391res.cook([<name>]) : string
15392scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15393 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15394 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15395 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020015396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015397 ACL derivatives :
15398 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020015399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015400res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15401scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15402 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15403 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
15404 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015406res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15407scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15408 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15409 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
15410 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015412res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15413 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
15414 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
15415 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
15416 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
15417 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
15418 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
15419 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
15420 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
15421 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015423res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15424 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
15425 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15426 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15427 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
15428 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015430res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15431shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
15432 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
15433 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
15434 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
15435 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
15436 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
15437 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
15438 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
15439 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015441 ACL derivatives :
15442 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15443 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15444 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15445 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15446 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15447 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15448 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15449 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15450
15451res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15452shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15453 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
15454 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15455 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
15456 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
15457 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015459res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15460shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15461 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
15462 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
15463 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
15464 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
15465 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
15466 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015467
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010015468res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
15469 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
15470 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
15471 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
15472 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
15473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015474res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15475shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15476 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
15477 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15478 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
15479 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
15480 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
15481 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010015482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015483res.ver : string
15484resp_ver : string (deprecated)
15485 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
15486 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015488 ACL derivatives :
15489 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010015490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015491set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15492 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15493 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015494 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015495 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015497 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
15498 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015500status : integer
15501 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
15502 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
15503 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015504
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020015505unique-id : string
15506 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
15507 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
15508 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
15509 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
15510 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
15511 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
15512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015513url : string
15514 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
15515 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
15516 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
15517 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
15518 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
15519 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
15520 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015521
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015522 ACL derivatives :
15523 url : exact string match
15524 url_beg : prefix match
15525 url_dir : subdir match
15526 url_dom : domain match
15527 url_end : suffix match
15528 url_len : length match
15529 url_reg : regex match
15530 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015532url_ip : ip
15533 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
15534 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
15535 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
15536 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
15537 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
15538 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
15539 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015541url_port : integer
15542 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
15543 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
15544 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
15545 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015546
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015547urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
15548url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015549 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
15550 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015551 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
15552 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
15553 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
15554 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015555 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
15556 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015557 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
15558 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015560 ACL derivatives :
15561 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
15562 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
15563 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
15564 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
15565 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
15566 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
15567 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
15568 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015569
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015571 Example :
15572 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
15573 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
15574 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
15575 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015576
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015577urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015578 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
15579 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
15580 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020015581
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020015582url32 : integer
15583 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
15584 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
15585 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
15586 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
15587 is an unsigned integer.
15588
15589url32+src : binary
15590 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
15591 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
15592 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
15593
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010015594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200155957.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015596---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015597
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015598Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
15599every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020015600order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015601
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015602ACL name Equivalent to Usage
15603---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015604FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020015605HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015606HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
15607HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015608HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
15609HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
15610HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
15611HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
15612LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015613METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020015614METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015615METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
15616METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
15617METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
15618METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020015619METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015620METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015621RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015622REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015623TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015624WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
15625---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015626
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010015627
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156288. Logging
15629----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010015630
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015631One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
15632provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
15633very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
15634provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
15635state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015636to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015637headers.
15638
15639In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
15640about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
15641send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
15642
15643 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
15644 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
15645 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
15646 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
15647 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015648 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060015649 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015650
15651The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
15652allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
15653as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
15654while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
15655real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
15656delay.
15657
15658
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156598.1. Log levels
15660---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015661
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015662TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015663source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015664HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
15665in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
15666track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
15667syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
15668about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015669
15670
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156718.2. Log formats
15672----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015673
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015674HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015675and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
15676slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
15677options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015678
15679 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
15680 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
15681 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
15682 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
15683 extents.
15684
15685 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
15686 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
15687 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
15688 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
15689 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
15690
15691 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
15692 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
15693 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
15694 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
15695 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
15696
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020015697 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
15698 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
15699 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
15700 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
15701
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015702 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
15703
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015704Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
15705specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
15706field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
15707servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
15708always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
15709identifier.
15710
15711Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
15712 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
15713 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
15714 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
15715 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
15716
15717
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157188.2.1. Default log format
15719-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015720
15721This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
15722as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
15723format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
15724
15725 Example :
15726 listen www
15727 mode http
15728 log global
15729 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15730
15731 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
15732 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
15733 (www/HTTP)
15734
15735 Field Format Extract from the example above
15736 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
15737 2 'Connect from' Connect from
15738 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
15739 4 'to' to
15740 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
15741 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
15742
15743Detailed fields description :
15744 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
15745 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
15746 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
15747 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
15748 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15749 and processed the connection.
15750 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
15751
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015752In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
15753"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
15754connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
15755
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015756It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
15757will eventually disappear.
15758
15759
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157608.2.2. TCP log format
15761---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015762
15763The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
15764is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
15765information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
15766counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
15767emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
15768environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
15769the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
15770sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015771specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
15772not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
15773fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
15774marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015775
15776 Example :
15777 frontend fnt
15778 mode tcp
15779 option tcplog
15780 log global
15781 default_backend bck
15782
15783 backend bck
15784 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15785
15786 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
15787 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
15788 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
15789
15790 Field Format Extract from the example above
15791 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
15792 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
15793 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
15794 4 frontend_name fnt
15795 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
15796 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
15797 7 bytes_read* 212
15798 8 termination_state --
15799 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
15800 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15801
15802Detailed fields description :
15803 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015804 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15805 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15806 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015807 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015808 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015809 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015810
15811 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015812 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15813 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15814 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015815
15816 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
15817 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
15818 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
15819 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
15820
15821 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15822 and processed the connection.
15823
15824 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15825 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15826 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
15827 applications.
15828
15829 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15830 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15831 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15832 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
15833 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
15834
15835 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15836 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15837 See "Timers" below for more details.
15838
15839 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15840 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15841 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
15842 "Timers" below for more details.
15843
15844 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015845 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015846 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
15847 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
15848 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
15849 details.
15850
15851 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
15852 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
15853 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
15854 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
15855 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
15856
15857 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15858 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15859 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
15860 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
15861 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
15862 for more details.
15863
15864 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015865 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015866 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
15867 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
15868 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015869 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015870
15871 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15872 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15873 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15874 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15875 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15876 caused by a denial of service attack.
15877
15878 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15879 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15880 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15881 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15882 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15883 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15884 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15885 denial of service attack.
15886
15887 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15888 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15889 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15890 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15891 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15892 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15893 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15894 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
15895 be processed than on other servers.
15896
15897 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15898 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15899 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15900 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15901 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15902 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15903 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15904 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15905 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15906 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15907 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15908 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15909 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15910
15911 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15912 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15913 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15914 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15915 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15916 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015917 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015918 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15919
15920 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15921 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15922 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15923 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15924 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15925 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015926 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015927 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15928 occurs.
15929
15930
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159318.2.3. HTTP log format
15932----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015933
15934The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
15935is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
15936the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
15937are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
15938emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
15939generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
15940"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
15941which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015942frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
15943is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015944
15945Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
15946slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
15947with a star ('*') after the field name below.
15948
15949 Example :
15950 frontend http-in
15951 mode http
15952 option httplog
15953 log global
15954 default_backend bck
15955
15956 backend static
15957 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15958
15959 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
15960 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
15961 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015962 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015963
15964 Field Format Extract from the example above
15965 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
15966 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015967 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015968 4 frontend_name http-in
15969 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015970 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015971 7 status_code 200
15972 8 bytes_read* 2750
15973 9 captured_request_cookie -
15974 10 captured_response_cookie -
15975 11 termination_state ----
15976 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
15977 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15978 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
15979 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
15980 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015981
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015982Detailed fields description :
15983 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015984 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15985 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15986 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015987 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015988 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015989 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015990
15991 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015992 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15993 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15994 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015995
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015996 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
15997 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015998
15999 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16000 and processed the connection.
16001
16002 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16003 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16004 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16005
16006 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16007 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16008 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16009 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16010 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16011 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
16012
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016013 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
16014 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
16015 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
16016 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
16017 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
16018 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
16019 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016020
16021 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16022 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16023 See "Timers" below for more details.
16024
16025 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16026 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16027 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
16028 below for more details.
16029
16030 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
16031 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
16032 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
16033 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
16034 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
16035 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
16036 for more details.
16037
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016038 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
16039 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
16040 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
16041 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
16042 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
16043 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
16044 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
16045 See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016046
16047 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
16048 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
16049 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
16050
16051 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
16052 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
16053 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
16054 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
16055 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
16056 overflowing.
16057
16058 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
16059 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
16060 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
16061 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
16062 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
16063 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
16064 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
16065 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16066
16067 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
16068 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
16069 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
16070 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
16071 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
16072 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
16073 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
16074 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16075
16076 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16077 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16078 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
16079 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
16080 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
16081 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
16082 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
16083
16084 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016085 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016086 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
16087 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
16088 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016089 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016090 system.
16091
16092 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16093 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16094 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16095 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16096 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16097 caused by a denial of service attack.
16098
16099 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16100 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16101 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16102 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16103 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16104 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16105 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16106 denial of service attack.
16107
16108 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16109 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16110 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16111 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16112 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16113 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16114 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16115 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
16116 processed than on other servers.
16117
16118 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16119 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16120 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16121 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16122 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16123 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16124 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16125 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16126 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16127 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16128 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16129 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16130 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16131
16132 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16133 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16134 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16135 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16136 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16137 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016138 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016139 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16140
16141 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16142 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16143 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16144 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16145 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16146 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016147 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016148 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16149 occurs.
16150
16151 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
16152 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
16153 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
16154 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
16155 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
16156 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
16157 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
16158 cookies" below for more details.
16159
16160 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
16161 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
16162 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
16163 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
16164 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
16165 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
16166 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
16167 and cookies" below for more details.
16168
16169 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
16170 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
16171 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
16172 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
16173 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
16174 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
16175 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
16176 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
16177
16178
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200161798.2.4. Custom log format
16180------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016181
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016182The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016183mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016184
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016185HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016186Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
16187separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
16188prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
16189
16190Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
16191variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016192("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016193
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016194If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020016195as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016196less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
16197the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
16198
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016199Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016200In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010016201in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016202
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016203Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
16204'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
16205https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
16206such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
16207
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016208Flags are :
16209 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016210 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016211 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
16212 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016213
16214 Example:
16215
16216 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
16217 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
16218
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016219 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
16220
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016221At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
16222
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016223 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
16224 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016225
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016226the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016227
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016228 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
16229 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
16230 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016231
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016232and the default TCP format is defined this way :
16233
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016234 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
16235 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016236
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016237Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
16238
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016239 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016240 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016241 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
16242 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
16243 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016244 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
16245 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
16246 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016247 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016248 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
16249 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000016250 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016251 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
16252 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010016253 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020016254 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016255 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016256 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016257 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020016258 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080016259 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016260 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
16261 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
16262 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
16263 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
16264 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016265 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016266 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
16267 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016268 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016269 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
16270 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016271 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16272 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
16273 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016274 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016275 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
16276 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016277 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016278 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16279 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
16280 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020016281 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020016282 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016283 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
16284 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
16285 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
16286 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020016287 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016288 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016289 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016290 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010016291 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016292 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016293 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
16294 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
16295 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016296 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016297 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
16298 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016299 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016300 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
16301 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
16302 | H | %trl | locla_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016303 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016304 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016305 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016306
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016307 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016308
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016309
163108.2.5. Error log format
16311-----------------------
16312
16313When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
16314protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
16315By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
16316"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016317will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016318logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
16319
16320The format looks like this :
16321
16322 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
16323 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
16324 Connection error during SSL handshake
16325
16326 Field Format Extract from the example above
16327 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
16328 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
16329 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
16330 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
16331 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
16332
16333These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
16334failures.
16335
16336
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163378.3. Advanced logging options
16338-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016339
16340Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
16341just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
16342options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
16343for more information about their usage.
16344
16345
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163468.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
16347------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016348
16349It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
16350haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
16351commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
16352monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
16353ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
16354
16355 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
16356 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
16357 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
16358 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
16359
16360 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
16361 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
16362 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016363 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016364 such as other load-balancers.
16365
16366 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
16367 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
16368 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
16369
16370
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163718.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
16372----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016373
16374The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
16375what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
16376or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016377"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016378just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
16379log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
16380after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
16381is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
16382with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
16383with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
16384
16385
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163868.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
16387------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016388
16389Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
16390for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
16391"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
16392retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
16393raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
16394a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
16395file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
16396you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
16397"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
16398
16399
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164008.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
16401--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016402
16403Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
16404multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
16405them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
16406"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
16407logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
16408error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
16409and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
16410too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
16411useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
16412alternative.
16413
16414
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164158.4. Timing events
16416------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016417
16418Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
16419reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
16420the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
16421frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016422mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
16423addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
16424
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010016425Timings events in HTTP mode:
16426
16427 first request 2nd request
16428 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
16429 t tr t tr ...
16430 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
16431 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
16432 :<---- Tq ---->: :
16433 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
16434 :<--------- Ta --------->:
16435
16436Timings events in TCP mode:
16437
16438 TCP session
16439 |<----------------->|
16440 t t
16441 ---|----|----|----|----|---
16442 | Th Tw Tc Td |
16443 |<------ Tt ------->|
16444
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016445 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016446 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016447 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
16448 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
16449 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016450 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016451 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016452
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016453 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
16454 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
16455 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
16456 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. Some
16457 browsers pre-establish connections to a server in order to reduce the
16458 latency of a future request, and keep them pending until they need it. This
16459 delay will be reported as the idle time. A value of -1 indicates that
16460 nothing was received on the connection.
16461
16462 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
16463 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
16464 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
16465 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
16466 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
16467 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
16468 request typed by hand during a test.
16469
16470 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
16471 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016472 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016473 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
16474 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
16475 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
16476 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016477
16478 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
16479 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
16480 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
16481 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
16482 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
16483
16484 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
16485 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
16486 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
16487 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
16488 connection never established.
16489
16490 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
16491 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
16492 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
16493 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
16494 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
16495 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
16496 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
16497 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
16498 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
16499 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
16500 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
16501
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016502 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
16503 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
16504 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
16505 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
16506 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
16507 by subtracting other timers when valid :
16508
16509 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
16510
16511 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
16512 "Ta" can never be negative.
16513
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016514 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
16515 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016516 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
16517 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016518 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016519
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016520 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016521
16522 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016523 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
16524 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016525
16526These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
16527protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
16528that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016529due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
16530"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
16531that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016532
16533Most common cases :
16534
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016535 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
16536 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
16537 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
16538 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
16539 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
16540 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
16541 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
16542 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
16543 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
16544 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
16545 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020016546 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016547
16548 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
16549 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
16550 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
16551 of ms on remote networks.
16552
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016553 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
16554 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
16555 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016556
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016557 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
16558 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
16559 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
16560 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
16561 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
16562 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
16563 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
16564 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
16565 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016566
16567Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
16568
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016569 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016570 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016571 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016572
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016573 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016574 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
16575 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
16576
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016577 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016578 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
16579 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
16580 flags.
16581
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016582 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
16583 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016584 Check the session termination flags, then check the
16585 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
16586 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
16587 the client connection was maintained open.
16588
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016589 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016590 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016591 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016592 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
16593
16594
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165958.5. Session state at disconnection
16596-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016597
16598TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
16599"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
166002-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
16601each of which has a special meaning :
16602
16603 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
16604 session to terminate :
16605
16606 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
16607
16608 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
16609 server explicitly refused it.
16610
16611 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
16612 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
16613 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
16614 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016615 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016616
16617 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
16618 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016619
16620 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
16621 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
16622 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
16623 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
16624 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
16625
16626 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
16627 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
16628 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
16629 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
16630 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
16631
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090016632 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
16633 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
16634
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016635 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
16636 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
16637 backup connections when going up.
16638
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020016639 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
16640
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016641 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
16642 send or receive data.
16643
16644 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
16645 send or receive data.
16646
16647 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
16648 with nothing left in the buffers.
16649
16650 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
16651
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010016652 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016653 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
16654
16655 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
16656 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
16657 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
16658 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
16659 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
16660
16661 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
16662 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
16663
16664 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
16665 server (HTTP only).
16666
16667 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
16668
16669 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
16670 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
16671 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
16672
16673 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
16674 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
16675 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
16676
16677 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
16678
16679 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
16680 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
16681
16682 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
16683 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
16684 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
16685
16686 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
16687 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020016688 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
16689 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016690
16691 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
16692 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
16693 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
16694 another server.
16695
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016696 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016697 server.
16698
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016699 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
16700 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
16701 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
16702 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
16703
16704 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
16705 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
16706 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
16707 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
16708
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020016709 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
16710 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
16711 "use-server" rule).
16712
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016713 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16714
16715 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
16716 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
16717
16718 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
16719
16720 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
16721 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
16722 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
16723
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016724 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
16725 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016726 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016727 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
16728 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
16729
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016730 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
16731
16732 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
16733 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
16734
16735 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
16736
16737 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16738
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016739The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
16740was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016741helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
16742starvation, attacks, etc...
16743
16744The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
16745alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
16746easier finding and understanding.
16747
16748 Flags Reason
16749
16750 -- Normal termination.
16751
16752 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
16753 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
16754 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
16755 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
16756
16757 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
16758 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
16759 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
16760 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
16761 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
16762 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016763
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016764 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16765 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016766 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016767
16768 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
16769 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
16770 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
16771
16772 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
16773 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
16774 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
16775 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
16776 the server takes too long to respond.
16777
16778 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
16779 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
16780 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
16781 long a time to respond.
16782
16783 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
16784 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
16785 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
16786 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016787 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
16788 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016789
16790 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
16791 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
16792 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
16793 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
16794 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020016795 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016796 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
16797 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
16798 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
16799 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
16800 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
16801 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
16802 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
16803 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016804 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016805 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
16806 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
16807 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016808
16809 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
16810 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016811 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
16812 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
16813 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
16814 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016815
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016816 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
16817 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
16818
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016819 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016820 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
16821 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016822 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016823 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
16824 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
16825
16826 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
16827 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
16828 503 or 504 here.
16829
16830 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
16831 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
16832 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
16833 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
16834 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
16835
16836 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16837 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016838 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016839 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
16840 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
16841
16842 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
16843 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
16844 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
16845 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
16846 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
16847 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
16848 between haproxy and the server.
16849
16850 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
16851 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
16852 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
16853 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
16854 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
16855 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
16856 solution is to fix the application.
16857
16858 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
16859 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
16860 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
16861 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
16862 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
16863 external attacks.
16864
16865 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
16866 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016867 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016868 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
16869 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
16870
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016871 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
16872 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
16873 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016874 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020016875 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016876
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016877 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
16878 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
16879 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
16880 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016881 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
16882 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
16883 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
16884 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
16885 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016886
16887 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
16888 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
16889 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
16890 returned an HTTP 403 error.
16891
16892 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
16893 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
16894 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
16895 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
16896
16897 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
16898 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
16899 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
16900 only be solved by proper system tuning.
16901
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016902The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
16903persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
16904important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
16905re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
16906
16907 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
16908
16909 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16910 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
16911 set on a GET request.
16912
16913 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
16914 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016915 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016916 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
16917
16918 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
16919 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
16920 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
16921
16922 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16923 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
16924 already got a cookie.
16925
16926 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16927 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
16928 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
16929 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
16930 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
16931
16932 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16933 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16934 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16935
16936 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
16937 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16938 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16939
16940 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
16941 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
16942
16943 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
16944 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
16945 then advertised in the response.
16946
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016947
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169488.6. Non-printable characters
16949-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016950
16951In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
16952consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
16953converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
16954prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
16955being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
16956escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
16957is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
16958'}' when logging headers.
16959
16960Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
16961issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
16962containing spaces is "User-Agent".
16963
16964Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
16965the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
16966performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
16967
16968
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169698.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
16970---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016971
16972Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
16973achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016974section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016975cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
16976the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
16977the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016978locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016979not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
16980user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
16981a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
16982wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
16983
16984 Examples :
16985 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
16986 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
16987
16988 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
16989 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
16990
16991
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169928.8. Capturing HTTP headers
16993---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016994
16995Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
16996proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
16997the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
16998server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
16999
17000Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17001response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017002section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017003
17004It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017005time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17006appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017007are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
17008and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
17009follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
17010request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
17011in the logs.
17012
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017013As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
17014frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
17015an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
17016
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017017 Example :
17018 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
17019 listen proxy-out
17020 mode http
17021 option httplog
17022 option logasap
17023 log global
17024 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
17025
17026 # log the name of the virtual server
17027 capture request header Host len 20
17028
17029 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
17030 capture request header Content-Length len 10
17031
17032 # log the beginning of the referrer
17033 capture request header Referer len 20
17034
17035 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
17036 capture response header Server len 20
17037
17038 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
17039 capture response header Content-Length len 10
17040
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017041 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017042 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
17043
17044 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
17045 capture response header Via len 20
17046
17047 # log the URL location during a redirection
17048 capture response header Location len 20
17049
17050 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
17051 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
17052 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17053 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
17054 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
17055
17056 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17057 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17058 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17059 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017060 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017061
17062 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17063 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17064 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17065 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
17066 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017067 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017068
17069
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170708.9. Examples of logs
17071---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017072
17073These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
17074them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
17075reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
17076
17077 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
17078 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17079 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17080
17081 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
17082 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
17083
17084 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
17085 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
17086 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17087
17088 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
17089 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
17090
17091 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
17092 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17093 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
17094
17095 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017096 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017097 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
17098 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
17099
17100 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
17101 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
17102 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
17103
17104 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
17105 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020017106 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017107 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
17108 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
17109 to return the 502 and not the server.
17110
17111 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017112 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017113
17114 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
17115 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
17116 Nothing was sent to any server.
17117
17118 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
17119 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
17120
17121 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
17122 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017123 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017124 send a 408 return code to the client.
17125
17126 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
17127 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
17128
17129 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
17130 5 seconds ("c----").
17131
17132 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
17133 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017134 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017135
17136 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017137 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017138 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
17139 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
17140 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
17141 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
17142 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017143
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020017144
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200171459. Supported filters
17146--------------------
17147
17148Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
17149accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
17150unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
17151
17152See also : "filter"
17153
171549.1. Trace
17155----------
17156
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017157filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017158
17159 Arguments:
17160 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
17161 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
17162
17163 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
17164 the client and the server. By default, this filter
17165 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
17166 only parses a random amount of the available data.
17167
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017168 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017169 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
17170 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
17171 amount of the parsed data.
17172
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017173 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017174
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017175This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
17176callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
17177information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
17178filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
17179
17180Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
17181tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
17182a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
17183
17184
171859.2. HTTP compression
17186---------------------
17187
17188filter compression
17189
17190The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
17191keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
17192when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
17193use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
17194used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
17195filters evaluation order.
17196
17197See also : "compression"
17198
17199
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200172009.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
17201--------------------------------------------
17202
17203filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
17204
17205 Arguments :
17206
17207 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
17208 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
17209 parsed.
17210
17211 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
17212 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
17213 part must be placed in its own scope.
17214
17215The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
17216external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017217streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017218exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
17219also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
17220
17221SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
17222the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
17223
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017224For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017225"doc/SPOE.txt".
17226
17227Important note:
17228 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
17229 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
17230
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001723110. Cache
17232---------
17233
17234HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
17235(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
17236RAM.
17237
17238The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017239this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017240
17241If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
17242independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
17243when we try to allocate a new one.
17244
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017245The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017246
17247It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
17248"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
17249for more details.
17250
17251When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
17252replaced by "<CACHE>".
17253
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001725410.1. Limitation
17255----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017256
17257The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
17258
17259- If the response is not a 200
17260- If the response contains a Vary header
17261- If the response does not contain a Content-Length header or if the
17262 Content-Length + the headers size is greater than a buffer size - the
17263 reserve.
17264- If the response is not cacheable
17265
17266- If the request is not a GET
17267- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020017268- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017269
17270Caution!: Due to the current limitation of the filters, it is not recommended
17271to use the cache with other filters. Using them can cause undefined behavior
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017272if they modify the response (compression for example).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017273
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001727410.2. Setup
17275-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017276
17277To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
17278the corresponding http-request and response actions.
17279
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001728010.2.1. Cache section
17281---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017282
17283cache <name>
17284 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
17285 size of cache is mandatory.
17286
17287total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017288 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
17289 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017290
17291max-age <seconds>
17292 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
17293 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
17294 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
17295 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
17296 default.
17297
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001729810.2.2. Proxy section
17299---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017300
17301http-request cache-use <name>
17302 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
17303 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
17304 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
17305 after this one.
17306
17307http-response cache-store <name>
17308 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
17309 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
17310 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
17311 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
17312
17313
17314Example:
17315
17316 backend bck1
17317 mode http
17318
17319 http-request cache-use foobar
17320 http-response cache-store foobar
17321 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
17322
17323 cache foobar
17324 total-max-size 4
17325 max-age 240
17326
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017327/*
17328 * Local variables:
17329 * fill-column: 79
17330 * End:
17331 */